Constify add_abbrev_prefix_cmd
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "ui-out.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
49 #include "block.h"
50 #include "solib.h"
51 #include "solist.h"
52 #include "observer.h"
53 #include "memattr.h"
54 #include "ada-lang.h"
55 #include "top.h"
56 #include "valprint.h"
57 #include "jit.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdb_regex.h"
60 #include "probe.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62 #include "continuations.h"
63 #include "stack.h"
64 #include "skip.h"
65 #include "ax-gdb.h"
66 #include "dummy-frame.h"
67 #include "interps.h"
68 #include "format.h"
69 #include "thread-fsm.h"
70 #include "tid-parse.h"
71
72 /* readline include files */
73 #include "readline/readline.h"
74 #include "readline/history.h"
75
76 /* readline defines this. */
77 #undef savestring
78
79 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
80 #include "extension.h"
81 #include <algorithm>
82 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
83 #include "common/array-view.h"
84 #include "common/gdb_optional.h"
85
86 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
87 enum exception_event_kind
88 {
89 EX_EVENT_THROW,
90 EX_EVENT_RETHROW,
91 EX_EVENT_CATCH
92 };
93
94 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
95
96 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
97 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
98
99 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
100
101 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
102
103 static void
104 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
105 struct linespec_result *canonical,
106 enum bptype type_wanted);
107
108 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
109 struct linespec_result *,
110 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
111 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
112 enum bptype,
113 enum bpdisp, int, int,
114 int,
115 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
116 int, int, int, unsigned);
117
118 static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
119 (struct breakpoint *b, const struct event_location *location,
120 struct program_space *search_pspace);
121
122 static void clear_command (char *, int);
123
124 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
125
126 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
127
128 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
129 enum bptype,
130 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
131 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
132 const struct symtab_and_line *);
133
134 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
135 static. */
136 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
137 struct symtab_and_line,
138 enum bptype,
139 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
140
141 static struct breakpoint *
142 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
143 enum bptype type,
144 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
145 int loc_enabled);
146
147 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
148
149 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
150 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
151 enum bptype bptype);
152
153 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
154 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
155 struct obj_section *, int);
156
157 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
158 struct bp_location *loc2);
159
160 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
161 const struct address_space *aspace,
162 CORE_ADDR addr);
163
164 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
165 const address_space *,
166 CORE_ADDR, int);
167
168 static void info_breakpoints_command (char *, int);
169
170 static void info_watchpoints_command (char *, int);
171
172 static void commands_command (char *, int);
173
174 static void condition_command (char *, int);
175
176 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
177 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
178
179 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
180
181 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
182
183 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
184
185 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
186 enum bptype type,
187 int *other_type_used);
188
189 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
190
191 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
192
193 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
194 int count);
195
196 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
197 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
198 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
199
200 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
201
202 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
203 insert locations now. */
204 enum ugll_insert_mode
205 {
206 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
207 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
208 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
209 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
210 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
211 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
212 returns true on them.
213
214 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
215 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
216 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
217 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
218 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
219 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
220 the inferior. */
221 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
222
223 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
224 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
225 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
226
227 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
228 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
229 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
230 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
231 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
232 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
233 as no thread is running yet. */
234 UGLL_INSERT
235 };
236
237 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
238
239 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
240
241 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
242
243 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
244
245 static void info_tracepoints_command (char *, int);
246
247 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
248
249 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
250
251 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
252
253 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
254
255 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
256
257 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
258
259 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
260 otherwise. */
261
262 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
263
264 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
265 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
266 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
267 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
268
269 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
270 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
271
272 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
273 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
274
275 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
276 breakpoints. */
277 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
278
279 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
280 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
281
282 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
283 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
284
285 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
286 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
287 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
288 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
289 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
290 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
291
292 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
293 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
294 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
295 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
296 dprintf_style_gdb,
297 dprintf_style_call,
298 dprintf_style_agent,
299 NULL
300 };
301 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
302
303 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
304 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
305 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
306 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
307
308 static char *dprintf_function;
309
310 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
311 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
312 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
313 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
314 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
315 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
316 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
317
318 static char *dprintf_channel;
319
320 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
321 has disconnected. */
322 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
323
324 struct command_line *
325 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
326 {
327 return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
328 }
329
330 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
331 current breakpoint. */
332
333 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
334
335 const char *
336 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
337 {
338 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
339 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
340 a breakpoint. */
341 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
342
343 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
344 }
345
346 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
347 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
348 if such is available. */
349 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
350
351 static void
352 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
353 struct cmd_list_element *c,
354 const char *value)
355 {
356 fprintf_filtered (file,
357 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
358 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
359 value);
360 }
361
362 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
363 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
364 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
365 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
366 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
367 static void
368 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
369 struct cmd_list_element *c,
370 const char *value)
371 {
372 fprintf_filtered (file,
373 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
374 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
375 value);
376 }
377
378 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
379 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
380 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
381 use hardware breakpoints. */
382 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
383 static void
384 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
385 struct cmd_list_element *c,
386 const char *value)
387 {
388 fprintf_filtered (file,
389 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
390 value);
391 }
392
393 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
394 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
395 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
396 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
397 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
398 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
399 processing user input. */
400 static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
401
402 static void
403 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
404 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
405 {
406 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
407 value);
408 }
409
410 /* See breakpoint.h. */
411
412 int
413 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
414 {
415 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
416 {
417 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
418 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
419 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
420 return 1;
421 }
422 else if (target_has_execution)
423 {
424 struct thread_info *tp;
425
426 if (always_inserted_mode)
427 {
428 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
429 are stopped. */
430 return 1;
431 }
432
433 if (threads_are_executing ())
434 return 1;
435
436 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
437 stopped, we still have events to process. */
438 ALL_NON_EXITED_THREADS (tp)
439 if (tp->resumed
440 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
441 return 1;
442 }
443 return 0;
444 }
445
446 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
447
448 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
449 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
450 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
451 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
452 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
453 condition_evaluation_auto,
454 condition_evaluation_host,
455 condition_evaluation_target,
456 NULL
457 };
458
459 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
460 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
461
462 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
463 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
464 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
465
466 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
467 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
468 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
469 evaluation mode. */
470
471 static const char *
472 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
473 {
474 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
475 {
476 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
477 return condition_evaluation_target;
478 else
479 return condition_evaluation_host;
480 }
481 else
482 return mode;
483 }
484
485 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
486
487 static const char *
488 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
489 {
490 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
491 }
492
493 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
494 otherwise. */
495
496 static int
497 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
498 {
499 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
500
501 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
502 }
503
504 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
505 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
506
507 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
508 static int overlay_events_enabled;
509
510 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
511 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
512
513 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
514 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
515 current breakpoint. */
516
517 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
518
519 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
520 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
521 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
522 B = TMP)
523
524 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
525 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
526 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
527
528 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
529 for (BP_TMP = bp_locations; \
530 BP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count && (B = *BP_TMP);\
531 BP_TMP++)
532
533 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
534 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
535 to where the loop should start from.
536 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
537 appropriate location to start with. */
538
539 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
540 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
541 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
542 BP_LOCP_START \
543 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count \
544 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
545 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
546
547 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
548
549 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
550 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
551 if (is_tracepoint (B))
552
553 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
554
555 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
556
557 /* Array is sorted by bp_locations_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
558
559 static struct bp_location **bp_locations;
560
561 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATIONS. */
562
563 static unsigned bp_locations_count;
564
565 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
566 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
567 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
568 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
569 an address you need to read. */
570
571 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
572
573 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
574 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
575 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
576 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
577 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
578
579 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
580
581 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
582 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
583 reported by a target. */
584 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
585
586 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
587
588 static int breakpoint_count;
589
590 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
591 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
592 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
593 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
594 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
595
596 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
597
598 static int tracepoint_count;
599
600 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
601 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
602 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
603
604 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
605
606 struct breakpoint *
607 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
608 void *user_data)
609 {
610 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
611
612 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
613 {
614 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
615 break;
616 }
617
618 return b;
619 }
620
621 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
622 static int
623 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
624 {
625 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
626 }
627
628 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
629
630 static void
631 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
632 {
633 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
634 breakpoint_count = num;
635 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
636 }
637
638 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
639 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
640 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
641
642 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
643 breakpoint made. */
644
645 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
646 {
647 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
648 }
649
650 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
651 breakpoint made. */
652
653 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
654 {
655 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
656 }
657
658 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
659
660 void
661 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
662 {
663 struct breakpoint *b;
664
665 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
666 b->hit_count = 0;
667 }
668
669 \f
670 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
671 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
672
673 struct breakpoint *
674 get_breakpoint (int num)
675 {
676 struct breakpoint *b;
677
678 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
679 if (b->number == num)
680 return b;
681
682 return NULL;
683 }
684
685 \f
686
687 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
688 evaluating conditions on its side. */
689
690 static void
691 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
692 {
693 struct bp_location *loc;
694
695 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
696 evaluating conditions and if the user has
697 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
698 side. */
699 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
700 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
701 return;
702
703 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
704 return;
705
706 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
707 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
708 }
709
710 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
711 evaluating conditions on its side. */
712
713 static void
714 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
715 {
716 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
717 evaluating conditions and if the user has
718 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
719 side. */
720 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
721 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
722
723 return;
724
725 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
726 return;
727
728 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
729 }
730
731 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
732 condition_evaluation_mode. */
733
734 static void
735 set_condition_evaluation_mode (char *args, int from_tty,
736 struct cmd_list_element *c)
737 {
738 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
739
740 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
741 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
742 {
743 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
744 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
745 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
746 return;
747 }
748
749 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
750 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
751
752 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
753 settings was "auto". */
754 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
755
756 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
757 if (new_mode != old_mode)
758 {
759 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
760 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
761 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
762
763 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
764 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
765 */
766
767 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
768 {
769 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
770 target. */
771 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
772 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
773 }
774 else
775 {
776 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
777 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
778 target knows about. */
779 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
780 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
781 loc->needs_update = 1;
782 }
783
784 /* Do the update. */
785 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
786 }
787
788 return;
789 }
790
791 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
792 what "auto" is translating to. */
793
794 static void
795 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
796 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
797 {
798 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
799 fprintf_filtered (file,
800 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
801 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
802 value,
803 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
804 else
805 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
806 value);
807 }
808
809 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
810 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
811 the more general bp_locations_compare function. */
812
813 static int
814 bp_locations_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
815 {
816 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
817 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
818
819 if (a->address == b->address)
820 return 0;
821 else
822 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
823 }
824
825 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
826 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
827 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
828 return NULL. */
829
830 static struct bp_location **
831 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
832 {
833 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
834 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
835 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
836
837 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
838 dummy_loc.address = address;
839
840 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
841 locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
842 bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_locations, bp_locations_count,
843 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
844 bp_locations_compare_addrs));
845
846 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
847 if (locp_found == NULL)
848 return NULL;
849
850 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
851 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
852 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_locations
853 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
854 locp_found--;
855
856 return locp_found;
857 }
858
859 void
860 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
861 int from_tty)
862 {
863 xfree (b->cond_string);
864 b->cond_string = NULL;
865
866 if (is_watchpoint (b))
867 {
868 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
869
870 w->cond_exp.reset ();
871 }
872 else
873 {
874 struct bp_location *loc;
875
876 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
877 {
878 loc->cond.reset ();
879
880 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
881 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
882 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
883 }
884 }
885
886 if (*exp == 0)
887 {
888 if (from_tty)
889 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
890 }
891 else
892 {
893 const char *arg = exp;
894
895 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
896 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
897 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
898 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
899
900 if (is_watchpoint (b))
901 {
902 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
903
904 innermost_block = NULL;
905 arg = exp;
906 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
907 if (*arg)
908 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
909 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
910 }
911 else
912 {
913 struct bp_location *loc;
914
915 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
916 {
917 arg = exp;
918 loc->cond =
919 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
920 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
921 if (*arg)
922 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
923 }
924 }
925 }
926 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
927
928 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
929 }
930
931 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
932
933 static void
934 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
935 completion_tracker &tracker,
936 const char *text, const char *word)
937 {
938 const char *space;
939
940 text = skip_spaces (text);
941 space = skip_to_space (text);
942 if (*space == '\0')
943 {
944 int len;
945 struct breakpoint *b;
946 VEC (char_ptr) *result = NULL;
947
948 if (text[0] == '$')
949 {
950 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
951 if (!isdigit (text[1]))
952 complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
953 return;
954 }
955
956 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
957 len = strlen (text);
958
959 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
960 {
961 char number[50];
962
963 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
964
965 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
966 {
967 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> copy (xstrdup (number));
968 tracker.add_completion (std::move (copy));
969 }
970 }
971
972 return;
973 }
974
975 /* We're completing the expression part. */
976 text = skip_spaces (space);
977 expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
978 }
979
980 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
981
982 static void
983 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
984 {
985 struct breakpoint *b;
986 char *p;
987 int bnum;
988
989 if (arg == 0)
990 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
991
992 p = arg;
993 bnum = get_number (&p);
994 if (bnum == 0)
995 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
996
997 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
998 if (b->number == bnum)
999 {
1000 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
1001 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
1002 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
1003 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
1004 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
1005
1006 if (extlang != NULL)
1007 {
1008 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
1009 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
1010 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
1011 }
1012 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
1013
1014 if (is_breakpoint (b))
1015 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
1016
1017 return;
1018 }
1019
1020 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
1021 }
1022
1023 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1024 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1025 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1026
1027 static void
1028 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1029 {
1030 struct command_line *c;
1031
1032 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1033 {
1034 int i;
1035
1036 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1037 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1038 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1039
1040 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
1041 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
1042
1043 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1044 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1045 command directly. */
1046 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1047 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1048
1049 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1050 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1051 }
1052 }
1053
1054 struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
1055 {
1056 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
1057 };
1058
1059 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1060
1061 static bool
1062 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
1063 {
1064 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1065 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1066 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1067 }
1068
1069 static bool
1070 is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
1071 {
1072 return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
1073 }
1074
1075 int
1076 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1077 {
1078 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1079 }
1080
1081 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1082 TYPE. */
1083
1084 static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
1085 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
1086 {
1087 breakpoint *b;
1088
1089 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
1090 b = new tracepoint ();
1091 else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
1092 b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1093 else
1094 b = new breakpoint ();
1095
1096 return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
1097 }
1098
1099 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1100 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1101 found. */
1102
1103 static void
1104 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1105 struct command_line *commands)
1106 {
1107 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1108 {
1109 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1110 struct command_line *c;
1111 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1112
1113 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1114 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1115 ones might not. */
1116 t->step_count = 0;
1117
1118 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1119 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1120 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1121 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1122 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1123 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1124 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1125 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1126 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1127 tracepoint's context. */
1128 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1129 {
1130 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1131 {
1132 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1133 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1134 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1135 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1136 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1137 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1138
1139 if (while_stepping)
1140 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1141 "can be used only once"));
1142 else
1143 while_stepping = c;
1144 }
1145
1146 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1147 }
1148 if (while_stepping)
1149 {
1150 struct command_line *c2;
1151
1152 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
1153 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
1154 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1155 {
1156 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1157 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1158 }
1159 }
1160 }
1161 else
1162 {
1163 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1164 }
1165 }
1166
1167 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1168 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1169
1170 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
1171 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1172 {
1173 struct breakpoint *b;
1174 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
1175 struct bp_location *loc;
1176
1177 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1178 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1179 {
1180 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1181 if (loc->address == addr)
1182 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
1183 }
1184
1185 return found;
1186 }
1187
1188 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1189 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1190
1191 void
1192 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1193 command_line_up &&commands)
1194 {
1195 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
1196
1197 b->commands = std::move (commands);
1198 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1199 }
1200
1201 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1202 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1203 commands. */
1204
1205 void
1206 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1207 {
1208 int old_silent = b->silent;
1209
1210 b->silent = silent;
1211 if (old_silent != silent)
1212 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1213 }
1214
1215 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1216 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1217
1218 void
1219 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1220 {
1221 int old_thread = b->thread;
1222
1223 b->thread = thread;
1224 if (old_thread != thread)
1225 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1226 }
1227
1228 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1229 breakpoint work for any task. */
1230
1231 void
1232 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1233 {
1234 int old_task = b->task;
1235
1236 b->task = task;
1237 if (old_task != task)
1238 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1239 }
1240
1241 void
1242 check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
1243 {
1244 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) closure;
1245
1246 validate_actionline (line, b);
1247 }
1248
1249 static void
1250 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1251 struct command_line *control)
1252 {
1253 counted_command_line cmd;
1254
1255 std::string new_arg;
1256
1257 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1258 {
1259 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1260 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1261 breakpoint_count);
1262 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1263 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1264 arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1265 }
1266
1267 map_breakpoint_numbers
1268 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
1269 {
1270 if (cmd == NULL)
1271 {
1272 if (control != NULL)
1273 cmd = copy_command_lines (control->body_list[0]);
1274 else
1275 {
1276 std::string str
1277 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1278 "%s, one per line."),
1279 arg);
1280
1281 cmd = read_command_lines (&str[0],
1282 from_tty, 1,
1283 (is_tracepoint (b)
1284 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
1285 b);
1286 }
1287 }
1288
1289 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1290 do anything. */
1291 if (b->commands != cmd)
1292 {
1293 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
1294 b->commands = cmd;
1295 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1296 }
1297 });
1298
1299 if (cmd == NULL)
1300 error (_("No breakpoints specified."));
1301 }
1302
1303 static void
1304 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1305 {
1306 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1307 }
1308
1309 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1310 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1311
1312 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1313 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1314 enum command_control_type
1315 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1316 {
1317 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1318 return simple_control;
1319 }
1320
1321 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1322
1323 static int
1324 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1325 {
1326 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1327 return 0;
1328 if (!bl->inserted)
1329 return 0;
1330 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1331 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1332 return 0;
1333 return 1;
1334 }
1335
1336 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1337 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1338 contents.
1339
1340 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1341 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1342 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1343
1344 static void
1345 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1346 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1347 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1348 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1349 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1350 {
1351 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1352 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1353 int bp_size = 0;
1354 int bptoffset = 0;
1355
1356 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1357 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1358 {
1359 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1360 return;
1361 }
1362
1363 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1364 we need to copy. */
1365 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1366 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1367
1368 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1369 {
1370 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1371 reading. */
1372 return;
1373 }
1374
1375 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1376 {
1377 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1378 reading. */
1379 return;
1380 }
1381
1382 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1383 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1384 {
1385 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1386 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1387 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1388 bp_addr = memaddr;
1389 }
1390
1391 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1392 {
1393 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1394 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1395 }
1396
1397 if (readbuf != NULL)
1398 {
1399 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1400 shadow_contents buffer. */
1401 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1402 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1403 + target_info->shadow_len));
1404
1405 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1406 shadow. */
1407 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1408 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1409 }
1410 else
1411 {
1412 const unsigned char *bp;
1413 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1414 int placed_size;
1415
1416 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1417 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1418 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1419
1420 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1421 address. */
1422 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1423
1424 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1425 breakpoint's INSN. */
1426 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1427 }
1428 }
1429
1430 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1431 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1432
1433 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1434 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1435 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1436
1437 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1438 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1439 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1440 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1441 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1442 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1443 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1444 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1445 and:
1446 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1447
1448 void
1449 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1450 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1451 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1452 {
1453 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1454 search. */
1455 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1456
1457 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1458 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1459 report higher one. */
1460
1461 bc_l = 0;
1462 bc_r = bp_locations_count;
1463 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1464 {
1465 struct bp_location *bl;
1466
1467 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1468 bl = bp_locations[bc];
1469
1470 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1471 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1472 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1473 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1474
1475 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1476 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1477 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1478
1479 if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1480 >= bl->address)
1481 && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1482 <= memaddr))
1483 bc_l = bc;
1484 else
1485 bc_r = bc;
1486 }
1487
1488 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1489 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1490 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1491 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1492 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1493 B:
1494
1495 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1496
1497 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1498 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1499 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1500 and L2. */
1501 while (bc_l > 0
1502 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
1503 bc_l--;
1504
1505 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1506
1507 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations_count; bc++)
1508 {
1509 struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
1510
1511 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1512 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1513 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1514 bl->owner->number);
1515
1516 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1517 content. */
1518
1519 if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1520 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1521 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))
1522 break;
1523
1524 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1525 continue;
1526
1527 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1528 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1529 }
1530 }
1531
1532 \f
1533
1534 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1535 breakpoint. */
1536
1537 int
1538 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1539 {
1540 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1541 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1542 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1543 }
1544
1545 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1546
1547 static int
1548 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1549 {
1550 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1551 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1552 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1553 }
1554
1555 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1556 software. */
1557
1558 int
1559 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1560 {
1561 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1562 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1563 }
1564
1565 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1566 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1567 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1568 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1569 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1570 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1571 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1572 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1573
1574 static int
1575 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1576 {
1577 return (b->pspace == current_program_space
1578 && (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1579 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1580 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))));
1581 }
1582
1583 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1584 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1585
1586 static void
1587 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1588 {
1589 if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
1590 {
1591 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1592 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
1593 w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1594 w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
1595 w->related_breakpoint = w;
1596 }
1597 w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1598 }
1599
1600 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1601 watchpoint W. */
1602
1603 static struct value *
1604 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1605 {
1606 struct value *bit_val;
1607
1608 if (val == NULL)
1609 return NULL;
1610
1611 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1612
1613 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1614 w->val_bitpos,
1615 w->val_bitsize,
1616 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1617 value_offset (val),
1618 val);
1619
1620 return bit_val;
1621 }
1622
1623 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1624 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1625 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1626 to be able to report stops. */
1627
1628 static void
1629 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1630 struct program_space *pspace)
1631 {
1632 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1633
1634 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1635 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1636 b->loc->address = -1;
1637 b->loc->length = -1;
1638 }
1639
1640 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1641 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1642
1643 static int
1644 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1645 {
1646 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1647 && b->loc != NULL
1648 && b->loc->next == NULL
1649 && b->loc->address == -1
1650 && b->loc->length == -1);
1651 }
1652
1653 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1654 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1655 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1656 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1657 in b->loc->cond.
1658 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1659
1660 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1661 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1662 it.
1663
1664 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1665 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1666 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1667 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1668 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1669 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1670 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1671 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1672
1673 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1674 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1675 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1676 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1677 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1678 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1679 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1680 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1681 not changed.
1682
1683 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1684 hardware watchpoints:
1685
1686 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1687 called several times when GDB stops.
1688
1689 [linux]
1690 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1691 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1692 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1693 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1694 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1695 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1696 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1697 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1698 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1699 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1700 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1701
1702 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1703 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1704
1705 static void
1706 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1707 {
1708 int within_current_scope;
1709 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1710 int frame_saved;
1711
1712 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1713 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1714 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1715 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1716 return;
1717
1718 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1719 return;
1720
1721 frame_saved = 0;
1722
1723 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1724 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1725 within_current_scope = 1;
1726 else
1727 {
1728 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1729 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1730 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1731
1732 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1733 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1734 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1735 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1736 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1737 return;
1738
1739 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1740 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1741 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1742 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1743 selected frame. */
1744 frame_saved = 1;
1745 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1746
1747 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1748 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1749 if (within_current_scope)
1750 select_frame (fi);
1751 }
1752
1753 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1754 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1755 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1756 b->loc = NULL;
1757
1758 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1759 {
1760 const char *s;
1761
1762 b->exp.reset ();
1763 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1764 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1765 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1766 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1767 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1768 be completely different objects. */
1769 value_free (b->val);
1770 b->val = NULL;
1771 b->val_valid = 0;
1772
1773 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1774 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1775 locations (re)created below. */
1776 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1777 {
1778 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1779
1780 s = b->cond_string;
1781 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1782 }
1783 }
1784
1785 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1786 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1787 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1788 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1789 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1790 if (!target_has_execution)
1791 {
1792 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1793 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1794 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1795 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1796 {
1797 if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1798 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1799 else
1800 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1801 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1802 }
1803 }
1804 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1805 {
1806 int pc = 0;
1807 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1808 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1809
1810 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1811
1812 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1813 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1814 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1815 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1816 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1817 watchpoints. */
1818 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
1819 {
1820 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1821 {
1822 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1823 if (v != NULL)
1824 release_value (v);
1825 }
1826 b->val = v;
1827 b->val_valid = 1;
1828 }
1829
1830 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1831
1832 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1833 for (v = val_chain; v; v = value_next (v))
1834 {
1835 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1836 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1837 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1838 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1839 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1840 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1841 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1842 {
1843 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1844
1845 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1846 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1847 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1848 if (v == result
1849 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1850 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1851 {
1852 CORE_ADDR addr;
1853 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1854 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1855 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1856
1857 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1858 {
1859 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1860 sub-expression. */
1861 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1862 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1863 }
1864 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1865 {
1866 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1867 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1868 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1869 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1870 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1871 }
1872
1873 addr = value_address (v);
1874 if (bitsize != 0)
1875 {
1876 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1877 addr += bitpos / 8;
1878 }
1879
1880 type = hw_write;
1881 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1882 type = hw_read;
1883 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1884 type = hw_access;
1885
1886 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1887 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1888 ;
1889 *tmp = loc;
1890 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1891
1892 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1893 loc->address = addr;
1894
1895 if (bitsize != 0)
1896 {
1897 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1898 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
1899 }
1900 else
1901 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1902
1903 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1904 }
1905 }
1906 }
1907
1908 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1909 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1910 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1911 is started. */
1912 if (reparse)
1913 {
1914 int reg_cnt;
1915 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1916 struct bp_location *bl;
1917
1918 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1919
1920 if (reg_cnt)
1921 {
1922 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
1923 enum bptype type;
1924
1925 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
1926 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
1927 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
1928
1929 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1930 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1931 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1932 this watchpoint in as well. */
1933
1934 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
1935 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
1936 hardware watchpoint type. */
1937 type = b->type;
1938 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
1939 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1940
1941 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
1942 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
1943 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
1944 through watch_command), so always account for it
1945 manually. */
1946
1947 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
1948 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
1949
1950 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
1951 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
1952
1953 target_resources_ok
1954 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
1955 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1956 {
1957 int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
1958
1959 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
1960 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
1961 "hardware watchpoint."));
1962 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
1963 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
1964 "resources for this watchpoint."));
1965
1966 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
1967 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1968 }
1969 else
1970 {
1971 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
1972 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
1973 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
1974 nop. */
1975 b->type = type;
1976 }
1977 }
1978 else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1979 {
1980 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1981 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1982 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1983 else
1984 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
1985 "read/access watchpoint."));
1986 }
1987 else
1988 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1989
1990 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
1991 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
1992 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
1993 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
1994 }
1995
1996 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1997 {
1998 next = value_next (v);
1999 if (v != b->val)
2000 value_free (v);
2001 }
2002
2003 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
2004 above left it without any location set up. But,
2005 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
2006 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
2007 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
2008 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
2009 }
2010 else if (!within_current_scope)
2011 {
2012 printf_filtered (_("\
2013 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
2014 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
2015 b->number);
2016 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
2017 }
2018
2019 /* Restore the selected frame. */
2020 if (frame_saved)
2021 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
2022 }
2023
2024
2025 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
2026 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
2027 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
2028 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
2029 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
2030 static int
2031 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2032 {
2033 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2034 return 0;
2035
2036 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2037 return 0;
2038
2039 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2040 return 0;
2041
2042 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2043 return 0;
2044
2045 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2046 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2047 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2048 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2049 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2050 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2051 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2052 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2053 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2054 return 0;
2055
2056 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2057 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2058 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2059 a breakpoint. */
2060 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2061 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2062 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2063 bl->address)
2064 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2065 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2066 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2067 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2068 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2069 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2070 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2071 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2072 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2073 {
2074 if (debug_infrun)
2075 {
2076 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2077 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2078 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2079 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2080 }
2081 return 0;
2082 }
2083
2084 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2085 instruction that triggered one. */
2086 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2087 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2088 {
2089 if (debug_infrun)
2090 {
2091 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2092 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2093 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2094 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2095 bl->length);
2096 }
2097 return 0;
2098 }
2099
2100 return 1;
2101 }
2102
2103 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2104 that the location is not duplicated. */
2105
2106 static int
2107 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2108 {
2109 int result;
2110 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2111
2112 bl->duplicate = 0;
2113 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2114 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2115 return result;
2116 }
2117
2118 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2119 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2120 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2121 any error during parsing. */
2122
2123 static agent_expr_up
2124 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2125 {
2126 if (cond == NULL)
2127 return NULL;
2128
2129 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2130
2131 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2132 that may show up. */
2133 TRY
2134 {
2135 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2136 }
2137
2138 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2139 {
2140 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2141 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2142 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2143 }
2144 END_CATCH
2145
2146 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2147 return aexpr;
2148 }
2149
2150 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2151 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2152 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2153 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2154 one of them is true. */
2155
2156 static void
2157 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2158 {
2159 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2160 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2161 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2162 struct bp_location *loc;
2163
2164 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2165 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2166
2167 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2168 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2169 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2170 side. */
2171 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2172 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2173 return;
2174
2175 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2176 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2177 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2178 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2179 response back to GDB. */
2180 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2181 {
2182 loc = (*loc2p);
2183 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2184 {
2185 if (modified)
2186 {
2187 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2188 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2189 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2190 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2191 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2192 loc->cond.get ());
2193 }
2194
2195 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2196 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2197 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2198 {
2199 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2200 break;
2201 }
2202 }
2203 }
2204
2205 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2206 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2207 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2208
2209 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2210 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2211 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2212 {
2213 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2214 {
2215 loc = (*loc2p);
2216 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2217 {
2218 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2219 located. */
2220 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2221 return;
2222
2223 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2224 }
2225 }
2226 }
2227
2228 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2229 for this location's address. */
2230 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2231 {
2232 loc = (*loc2p);
2233 if (loc->cond
2234 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2235 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2236 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2237 && loc->enabled)
2238 {
2239 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2240 to send the conditions to the target. */
2241 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2242 }
2243 }
2244
2245 return;
2246 }
2247
2248 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2249 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2250 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2251
2252 static agent_expr_up
2253 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2254 {
2255 struct cleanup *old_cleanups = 0;
2256 struct expression **argvec;
2257 const char *cmdrest;
2258 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2259 struct format_piece *fpieces;
2260 int nargs;
2261 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2262
2263 if (cmd == NULL)
2264 return NULL;
2265
2266 cmdrest = cmd;
2267
2268 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2269 ++cmdrest;
2270 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2271
2272 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2273 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2274
2275 format_start = cmdrest;
2276
2277 fpieces = parse_format_string (&cmdrest);
2278
2279 old_cleanups = make_cleanup (free_format_pieces_cleanup, &fpieces);
2280
2281 format_end = cmdrest;
2282
2283 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2284 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2285
2286 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2287
2288 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2289 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2290
2291 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2292 cmdrest++;
2293 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2294
2295 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2296
2297 argvec = (struct expression **) alloca (strlen (cmd)
2298 * sizeof (struct expression *));
2299
2300 nargs = 0;
2301 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2302 {
2303 const char *cmd1;
2304
2305 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2306 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2307 argvec[nargs++] = expr.release ();
2308 cmdrest = cmd1;
2309 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2310 ++cmdrest;
2311 }
2312
2313 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2314
2315 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2316 that may show up. */
2317 TRY
2318 {
2319 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2320 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2321 fpieces, nargs, argvec);
2322 }
2323 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2324 {
2325 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2326 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2327 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2328 }
2329 END_CATCH
2330
2331 do_cleanups (old_cleanups);
2332
2333 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2334 return aexpr;
2335 }
2336
2337 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2338 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2339 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2340
2341 static void
2342 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2343 {
2344 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2345 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2346 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2347 struct bp_location *loc;
2348
2349 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2350 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2351
2352 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2353 return;
2354
2355 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2356 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2357 return;
2358
2359 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2360 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2361 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2362 control. */
2363 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2364 {
2365 loc = (*loc2p);
2366 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2367 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2368 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2369 return;
2370 }
2371
2372 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2373 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2374 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2375 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2376 response back to GDB. */
2377 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2378 {
2379 loc = (*loc2p);
2380 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2381 {
2382 if (modified)
2383 {
2384 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2385 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2386 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2387 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2388 loc->cmd_bytecode
2389 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2390 loc->owner->extra_string);
2391 }
2392
2393 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2394 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2395 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2396 {
2397 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2398 break;
2399 }
2400 }
2401 }
2402
2403 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2404 and so clean up. */
2405 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2406 {
2407 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2408 {
2409 loc = (*loc2p);
2410 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2411 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2412 {
2413 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2414 located. */
2415 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2416 return;
2417
2418 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2419 }
2420 }
2421 }
2422
2423 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2424 for this location's address. */
2425 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2426 {
2427 loc = (*loc2p);
2428 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2429 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2430 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2431 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2432 && loc->enabled)
2433 {
2434 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2435 to send the commands to the target. */
2436 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2437 }
2438 }
2439
2440 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2441 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2442 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2443 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2444 }
2445
2446 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2447 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2448 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2449 registers state. */
2450
2451 static int
2452 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2453 {
2454 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2455 {
2456 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2457 struct regcache *regcache;
2458
2459 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr->ptid);
2460
2461 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2462 regcache, addr);
2463 }
2464 else
2465 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2466 }
2467
2468 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2469 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2470 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2471 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2472 -1 for failure.
2473
2474 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2475 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2476 static int
2477 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2478 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2479 int *disabled_breaks,
2480 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2481 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2482 {
2483 enum errors bp_err = GDB_NO_ERROR;
2484 const char *bp_err_message = NULL;
2485
2486 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2487 return 0;
2488
2489 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2490 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2491 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2492 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2493 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2494 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2495 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2496 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2497 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2498 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2499 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2500 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2501
2502 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2503 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2504 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2505 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2506
2507 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2508 {
2509 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2510 build_target_command_list (bl);
2511 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2512 bl->needs_update = 0;
2513 }
2514
2515 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2516 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2517 {
2518 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2519 {
2520 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2521 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2522 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2523
2524 Two important cases are:
2525 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2526 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2527 hardware breakpoint.
2528 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2529 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2530 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2531 so we undo.
2532
2533 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2534 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2535 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2536 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2537 gdb. */
2538 struct mem_region *mr
2539 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2540
2541 if (mr)
2542 {
2543 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2544 {
2545 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2546
2547 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2548 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2549 else
2550 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2551
2552 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2553 {
2554 static int said = 0;
2555
2556 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2557 if (!said)
2558 {
2559 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2560 _("Note: automatically using "
2561 "hardware breakpoints for "
2562 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2563 said = 1;
2564 }
2565 }
2566 }
2567 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2568 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2569 {
2570 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2571 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2572 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2573 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2574 bl->owner->number,
2575 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2576 return 1;
2577 }
2578 }
2579 }
2580
2581 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2582 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2583 || bl->section == NULL
2584 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2585 {
2586 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2587 TRY
2588 {
2589 int val;
2590
2591 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2592 if (val)
2593 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2594 }
2595 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2596 {
2597 bp_err = e.error;
2598 bp_err_message = e.message;
2599 }
2600 END_CATCH
2601 }
2602 else
2603 {
2604 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2605 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2606 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2607 {
2608 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2609 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2610 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2611 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2612 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2613 bl->owner->number);
2614 else
2615 {
2616 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2617 bl->section);
2618 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2619 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2620 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2621
2622 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2623 TRY
2624 {
2625 int val;
2626
2627 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2628 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2629 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2630 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2631 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2632 if (val)
2633 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2634 }
2635 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2636 {
2637 bp_err = e.error;
2638 bp_err_message = e.message;
2639 }
2640 END_CATCH
2641
2642 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2643 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2644 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2645 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2646 bl->owner->number);
2647 }
2648 }
2649 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2650 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2651 {
2652 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2653 TRY
2654 {
2655 int val;
2656
2657 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2658 if (val)
2659 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2660 }
2661 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2662 {
2663 bp_err = e.error;
2664 bp_err_message = e.message;
2665 }
2666 END_CATCH
2667 }
2668 else
2669 {
2670 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2671 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2672 return 0;
2673 }
2674 }
2675
2676 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2677 {
2678 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2679
2680 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2681 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2682 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2683 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2684 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2685 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2686 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2687 errors as memory errors. */
2688 if ((bp_err == GENERIC_ERROR || bp_err == MEMORY_ERROR)
2689 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2690 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2691 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2692 bl->address)))
2693 {
2694 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2695 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2696 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner);
2697 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2698 {
2699 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2700 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2701 bl->owner->number);
2702 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2703 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2704 "library breakpoints:\n");
2705 }
2706 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2707 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2708 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2709 return 0;
2710 }
2711 else
2712 {
2713 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2714 {
2715 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2716 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_err_message != NULL;
2717 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2718 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2719 bl->owner->number, bp_err_message ? ":" : ".\n");
2720 if (bp_err_message != NULL)
2721 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n", bp_err_message);
2722 }
2723 else
2724 {
2725 if (bp_err_message == NULL)
2726 {
2727 std::string message
2728 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2729 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2730
2731 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2732 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2733 "%s\n",
2734 bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
2735 }
2736 else
2737 {
2738 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2739 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2740 bl->owner->number,
2741 bp_err_message);
2742 }
2743 }
2744 return 1;
2745
2746 }
2747 }
2748 else
2749 bl->inserted = 1;
2750
2751 return 0;
2752 }
2753
2754 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2755 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2756 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2757 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2758 {
2759 int val;
2760
2761 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2762 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2763
2764 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2765
2766 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2767 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2768 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2769 {
2770 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2771
2772 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2773 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2774 of this one. */
2775 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2776 if (loc != bl
2777 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2778 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2779 {
2780 bl->duplicate = 1;
2781 bl->inserted = 1;
2782 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2783 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2784 val = 0;
2785 break;
2786 }
2787
2788 if (val == 1)
2789 {
2790 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2791 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2792
2793 if (val)
2794 /* Back to the original value. */
2795 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2796 }
2797 }
2798
2799 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2800 }
2801
2802 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2803 {
2804 int val;
2805
2806 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2807 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2808
2809 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2810 if (val)
2811 {
2812 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2813
2814 if (val == 1)
2815 warning (_("\
2816 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2817 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2818 else
2819 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2820 }
2821
2822 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2823
2824 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2825 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2826 so just return success. */
2827 return 0;
2828 }
2829
2830 return 0;
2831 }
2832
2833 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2834 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2835 PSPACE anymore. */
2836
2837 void
2838 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2839 {
2840 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2841 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2842
2843 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2844 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2845 {
2846 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2847 delete_breakpoint (b);
2848 }
2849
2850 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2851 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2852 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2853 {
2854 struct bp_location *tmp;
2855
2856 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2857 {
2858 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2859 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2860 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2861 else
2862 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2863 if (tmp->next == loc)
2864 {
2865 tmp->next = loc->next;
2866 break;
2867 }
2868 }
2869 }
2870
2871 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2872 removed locations above. */
2873 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2874 }
2875
2876 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2877 Throws exception on any error.
2878 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2879 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2880 void
2881 insert_breakpoints (void)
2882 {
2883 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2884
2885 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2886 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2887 {
2888 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2889
2890 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2891 }
2892
2893 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2894 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2895 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
2896 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2897 }
2898
2899 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2900
2901 void
2902 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
2903 {
2904 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
2905
2906 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
2907 {
2908 callback (loc, NULL);
2909 }
2910 }
2911
2912 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2913 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2914 always-inserted mode. */
2915
2916 static void
2917 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2918 {
2919 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2920 int error_flag = 0;
2921 int val = 0;
2922 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2923 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2924 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2925
2926 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2927
2928 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2929 there was an error. */
2930 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2931
2932 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2933
2934 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2935 {
2936 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2937 breakpoints. */
2938 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2939 continue;
2940
2941 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2942 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2943 deletion of breakpoints. */
2944 if (!bl->inserted || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2945 continue;
2946
2947 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2948
2949 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2950 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2951 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2952 insert breakpoints. */
2953 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2954 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2955 continue;
2956
2957 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2958 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2959 if (val)
2960 error_flag = val;
2961 }
2962
2963 if (error_flag)
2964 {
2965 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2966 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2967 }
2968 }
2969
2970 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2971
2972 static void
2973 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2974 {
2975 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2976 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2977 int error_flag = 0;
2978 int val = 0;
2979 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2980 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2981 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2982
2983 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2984
2985 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2986 there was an error. */
2987 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2988
2989 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2990
2991 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2992 {
2993 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2994 continue;
2995
2996 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2997 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2998 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2999 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
3000 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
3001 continue;
3002
3003 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3004
3005 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3006 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3007 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3008 insert breakpoints. */
3009 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3010 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3011 continue;
3012
3013 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3014 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
3015 if (val)
3016 error_flag = val;
3017 }
3018
3019 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
3020 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
3021 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3022 {
3023 int some_failed = 0;
3024 struct bp_location *loc;
3025
3026 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3027 continue;
3028
3029 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
3030 continue;
3031
3032 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
3033 continue;
3034
3035 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3036 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3037 {
3038 some_failed = 1;
3039 break;
3040 }
3041 if (some_failed)
3042 {
3043 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3044 if (loc->inserted)
3045 remove_breakpoint (loc);
3046
3047 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3048 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
3049 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3050 bpt->number);
3051 error_flag = -1;
3052 }
3053 }
3054
3055 if (error_flag)
3056 {
3057 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3058 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3059 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3060 {
3061 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3062 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3063 }
3064 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
3065 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3066 }
3067 }
3068
3069 /* Used when the program stops.
3070 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3071 removing a breakpoint location. */
3072
3073 int
3074 remove_breakpoints (void)
3075 {
3076 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3077 int val = 0;
3078
3079 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3080 {
3081 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3082 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3083 }
3084 return val;
3085 }
3086
3087 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3088 that thread. */
3089
3090 static void
3091 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3092 {
3093 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3094
3095 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3096 {
3097 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3098 {
3099 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3100
3101 printf_filtered (_("\
3102 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3103 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3104
3105 /* Hide it from the user. */
3106 b->number = 0;
3107 }
3108 }
3109 }
3110
3111 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
3112
3113 int
3114 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
3115 {
3116 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3117 int val;
3118 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3119
3120 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3121 {
3122 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3123 continue;
3124
3125 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3126 {
3127 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3128 if (val != 0)
3129 return val;
3130 }
3131 }
3132 return 0;
3133 }
3134
3135 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3136
3137 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3138 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3139 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3140 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3141 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3142 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3143 static void
3144 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3145 {
3146 if (internal)
3147 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3148 else
3149 {
3150 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3151 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3152 }
3153 }
3154
3155 static struct breakpoint *
3156 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3157 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3158 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3159 {
3160 symtab_and_line sal;
3161 sal.pc = address;
3162 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3163 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3164
3165 breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3166 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3167 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3168
3169 return b;
3170 }
3171
3172 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3173 {
3174 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3175 };
3176 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3177
3178 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3179 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3180 {
3181 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3182 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym {};
3183
3184 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3185 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES] {};
3186
3187 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3188 int longjmp_searched = 0;
3189
3190 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3191 references. */
3192 std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
3193
3194 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3195 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym {};
3196
3197 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3198 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym {};
3199
3200 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3201 int exception_searched = 0;
3202
3203 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3204 references. */
3205 std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
3206 };
3207
3208 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3209
3210 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3211 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3212
3213 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3214
3215 static int
3216 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3217 {
3218 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3219 }
3220
3221 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3222 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3223
3224 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3225 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3226 {
3227 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3228
3229 bp_objfile_data = ((struct breakpoint_objfile_data *)
3230 objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key));
3231 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3232 {
3233 bp_objfile_data = new breakpoint_objfile_data ();
3234 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3235 }
3236 return bp_objfile_data;
3237 }
3238
3239 static void
3240 free_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3241 {
3242 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3243 = (struct breakpoint_objfile_data *) data;
3244
3245 delete bp_objfile_data;
3246 }
3247
3248 static void
3249 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3250 {
3251 struct objfile *objfile;
3252 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3253
3254 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3255 {
3256 struct breakpoint *b;
3257 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3258 CORE_ADDR addr;
3259 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3260
3261 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3262
3263 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3264 continue;
3265
3266 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3267 {
3268 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3269
3270 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3271 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3272 {
3273 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3274 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3275 continue;
3276 }
3277 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3278 }
3279
3280 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3281 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3282 bp_overlay_event,
3283 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3284 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3285 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3286 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3287
3288 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3289 {
3290 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3291 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3292 }
3293 else
3294 {
3295 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3296 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3297 }
3298 }
3299 }
3300
3301 static void
3302 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3303 {
3304 struct program_space *pspace;
3305
3306 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3307
3308 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3309 {
3310 struct objfile *objfile;
3311
3312 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3313
3314 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3315 {
3316 int i;
3317 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3318 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3319
3320 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3321
3322 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3323
3324 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3325 {
3326 std::vector<probe *> ret
3327 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3328
3329 if (!ret.empty ())
3330 {
3331 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3332 probe *p = ret[0];
3333
3334 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3335 {
3336 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3337 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3338 ret.clear ();
3339 }
3340 }
3341 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3342 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3343 }
3344
3345 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
3346 {
3347 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3348
3349 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
3350 {
3351 struct breakpoint *b;
3352
3353 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3354 get_probe_address (p, objfile),
3355 bp_longjmp_master,
3356 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3357 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3358 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3359 }
3360
3361 continue;
3362 }
3363
3364 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3365 continue;
3366
3367 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3368 {
3369 struct breakpoint *b;
3370 const char *func_name;
3371 CORE_ADDR addr;
3372 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3373
3374 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3375 continue;
3376
3377 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3378 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3379 {
3380 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3381
3382 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3383 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3384 {
3385 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3386 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3387 continue;
3388 }
3389 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3390 }
3391
3392 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3393 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3394 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3395 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3396 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3397 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3398 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3399 }
3400 }
3401 }
3402 }
3403
3404 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3405 static void
3406 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3407 {
3408 struct program_space *pspace;
3409 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3410
3411 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3412
3413 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3414 {
3415 struct objfile *objfile;
3416 CORE_ADDR addr;
3417
3418 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3419
3420 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3421 {
3422 struct breakpoint *b;
3423 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3424 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3425
3426 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3427
3428 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3429 continue;
3430
3431 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3432 {
3433 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3434
3435 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3436 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3437 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3438 {
3439 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3440 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3441 continue;
3442 }
3443 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3444 }
3445
3446 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3447 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3448 bp_std_terminate_master,
3449 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3450 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3451 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3452 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3453 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3454 }
3455 }
3456 }
3457
3458 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3459
3460 static void
3461 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3462 {
3463 struct objfile *objfile;
3464 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3465
3466 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3467 {
3468 struct breakpoint *b;
3469 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3470 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3471 CORE_ADDR addr;
3472 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3473
3474 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3475
3476 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3477 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3478 {
3479 std::vector<probe *> ret
3480 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3481
3482 if (!ret.empty ())
3483 {
3484 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3485 probe *p = ret[0];
3486
3487 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3488 {
3489 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3490 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3491 ret.clear ();
3492 }
3493 }
3494 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3495 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3496 }
3497
3498 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
3499 {
3500 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3501
3502 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
3503 {
3504 struct breakpoint *b;
3505
3506 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3507 get_probe_address (p, objfile),
3508 bp_exception_master,
3509 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3510 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3511 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3512 }
3513
3514 continue;
3515 }
3516
3517 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3518
3519 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3520 continue;
3521
3522 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3523
3524 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3525 {
3526 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3527
3528 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3529 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3530 {
3531 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3532 continue;
3533 }
3534
3535 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3536 }
3537
3538 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3539 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3540 &current_target);
3541 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3542 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3543 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3544 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3545 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3546 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3547 }
3548 }
3549
3550 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3551
3552 static int
3553 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3554 {
3555 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
3556 }
3557
3558 void
3559 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3560 {
3561 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3562 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3563
3564 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3565 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3566 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3567 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3568 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3569 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3570 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3571 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3572 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3573 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3574 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3575
3576 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3577 {
3578 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3579 continue;
3580
3581 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3582 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3583 {
3584 delete_breakpoint (b);
3585 continue;
3586 }
3587
3588 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3589 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3590 {
3591 delete_breakpoint (b);
3592 continue;
3593 }
3594
3595 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3596 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3597 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3598 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3599 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3600 {
3601 delete_breakpoint (b);
3602 continue;
3603 }
3604
3605 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3606 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3607 {
3608 delete_breakpoint (b);
3609 continue;
3610 }
3611
3612 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3613 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3614 {
3615 delete_breakpoint (b);
3616 continue;
3617 }
3618
3619 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3620 after an exec. */
3621 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3622 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3623 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3624 {
3625 delete_breakpoint (b);
3626 continue;
3627 }
3628
3629 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3630 {
3631 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3632 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3633 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3634 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3635 continue;
3636 }
3637
3638 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3639 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3640 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3641 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3642 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3643 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3644
3645 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3646 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3647 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3648 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3649 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3650 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3651 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3652
3653 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3654 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3655 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3656 let finish_command delete it.
3657
3658 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3659 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3660 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3661 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3662 solib breakpoints.) */
3663
3664 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3665 {
3666 continue;
3667 }
3668
3669 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3670 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3671 a.out. */
3672 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3673 {
3674 delete_breakpoint (b);
3675 continue;
3676 }
3677 }
3678 }
3679
3680 int
3681 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3682 {
3683 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3684 int val = 0;
3685 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
3686 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3687
3688 if (ptid_get_pid (ptid) == ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid))
3689 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3690
3691 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3692 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3693 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3694 {
3695 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3696 continue;
3697
3698 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3699 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3700 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3701 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3702 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3703 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3704 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3705 continue;
3706
3707 if (bl->inserted)
3708 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3709 }
3710
3711 return val;
3712 }
3713
3714 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3715 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3716 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3717 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3718 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3719
3720 static int
3721 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3722 {
3723 int val;
3724
3725 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3726 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3727
3728 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3729 This should not ever happen. */
3730 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3731
3732 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3733 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3734 {
3735 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3736 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3737 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3738
3739 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3740 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3741 || bl->section == NULL
3742 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3743 {
3744 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3745
3746 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3747 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3748 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3749 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3750 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3751 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3752 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3753 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3754 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3755 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3756 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3757 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3758 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3759 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3760 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3761 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3762 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3763 they should always be removed. */
3764 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3765 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3766 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3767 val = 0;
3768 else
3769 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3770 }
3771 else
3772 {
3773 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3774 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3775 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3776 {
3777 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3778 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3779 */
3780 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3781 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3782 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3783 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3784 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3785 else
3786 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3787 &bl->overlay_target_info,
3788 reason);
3789 }
3790 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3791 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3792 if (bl->inserted)
3793 {
3794 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3795 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3796 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3797 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3798
3799 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3800 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3801 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3802 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3803 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3804 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3805 else
3806 val = 0;
3807 }
3808 else
3809 {
3810 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3811 val = 0;
3812 }
3813 }
3814
3815 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3816 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3817 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3818 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3819 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3820 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3821 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3822 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3823 always-inserted mode. */
3824 if (val
3825 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3826 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3827 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3828 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3829 bl->address))))
3830 val = 0;
3831
3832 if (val)
3833 return val;
3834 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3835 }
3836 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3837 {
3838 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3839 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3840
3841 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3842 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3843
3844 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3845 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
3846 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3847 bl->owner->number);
3848 }
3849 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3850 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3851 && !bl->duplicate)
3852 {
3853 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3854 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3855
3856 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3857 if (val)
3858 return val;
3859
3860 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3861 }
3862
3863 return 0;
3864 }
3865
3866 static int
3867 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
3868 {
3869 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3870 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3871
3872 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3873 This should not ever happen. */
3874 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3875
3876 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3877
3878 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3879
3880 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
3881 }
3882
3883 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3884
3885 void
3886 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3887 {
3888 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3889
3890 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3891 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3892 bl->inserted = 0;
3893 }
3894
3895 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3896 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3897
3898 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3899 between runs.
3900
3901 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3902 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3903 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3904
3905
3906
3907 void
3908 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3909 {
3910 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3911 struct bp_location *bl;
3912 int ix;
3913 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3914
3915 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3916 nothing to do. */
3917 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3918 return;
3919
3920 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3921
3922 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3923 {
3924 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3925 continue;
3926
3927 switch (b->type)
3928 {
3929 case bp_call_dummy:
3930 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3931
3932 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3933 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3934 rid of it. */
3935
3936 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3937
3938 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3939
3940 case bp_shlib_event:
3941
3942 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3943 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3944 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3945 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3946 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3947
3948 (gdb) file prog-linux
3949 (gdb) run # native linux target
3950 ...
3951 (gdb) kill
3952 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3953 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3954 */
3955
3956 case bp_step_resume:
3957
3958 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3959
3960 case bp_single_step:
3961
3962 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
3963
3964 delete_breakpoint (b);
3965 break;
3966
3967 case bp_watchpoint:
3968 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3969 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3970 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3971 {
3972 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
3973
3974 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
3975 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
3976 delete_breakpoint (b);
3977 else
3978 {
3979 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
3980 valid. New ones will be created in
3981 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
3982 The next update_global_location_list call will
3983 garbage collect them. */
3984 b->loc = NULL;
3985
3986 if (context == inf_starting)
3987 {
3988 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
3989 insert_breakpoints. */
3990 if (w->val)
3991 value_free (w->val);
3992 w->val = NULL;
3993 w->val_valid = 0;
3994 }
3995 }
3996 }
3997 break;
3998 default:
3999 break;
4000 }
4001 }
4002
4003 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
4004 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
4005 decref_bp_location (&bl);
4006 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
4007 }
4008
4009 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
4010 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
4011 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
4012 match, not program space. */
4013
4014 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
4015 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
4016 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
4017 permanent breakpoint.
4018 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
4019 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
4020 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
4021 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
4022 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
4023
4024 enum breakpoint_here
4025 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4026 {
4027 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4028 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
4029
4030 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4031 {
4032 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4033 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4034 continue;
4035
4036 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4037 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4038 || bl->permanent)
4039 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4040 {
4041 if (overlay_debugging
4042 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4043 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4044 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4045 else if (bl->permanent)
4046 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
4047 else
4048 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4049 }
4050 }
4051
4052 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4053 }
4054
4055 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4056
4057 int
4058 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
4059 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4060 {
4061 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4062
4063 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4064 {
4065 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4066 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4067 continue;
4068
4069 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4070 || bl->permanent)
4071 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
4072 addr, len))
4073 {
4074 if (overlay_debugging
4075 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4076 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4077 {
4078 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4079 continue;
4080 }
4081
4082 return 1;
4083 }
4084 }
4085
4086 return 0;
4087 }
4088
4089 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4090
4091 int
4092 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4093 {
4094 struct bp_location *loc;
4095 int ix;
4096
4097 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4098 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4099 return 1;
4100
4101 return 0;
4102 }
4103
4104 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4105 ASPACE. */
4106
4107 static int
4108 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4109 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4110 {
4111 if (bl->inserted
4112 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4113 aspace, pc))
4114 {
4115 if (overlay_debugging
4116 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4117 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4118 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4119 else
4120 return 1;
4121 }
4122 return 0;
4123 }
4124
4125 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4126
4127 int
4128 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4129 {
4130 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4131
4132 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4133 {
4134 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4135
4136 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4137 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4138 continue;
4139
4140 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4141 return 1;
4142 }
4143 return 0;
4144 }
4145
4146 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4147 inserted at PC. */
4148
4149 int
4150 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4151 CORE_ADDR pc)
4152 {
4153 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4154
4155 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4156 {
4157 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4158
4159 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4160 continue;
4161
4162 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4163 return 1;
4164 }
4165
4166 return 0;
4167 }
4168
4169 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4170
4171 int
4172 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4173 CORE_ADDR pc)
4174 {
4175 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4176
4177 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4178 {
4179 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4180
4181 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4182 continue;
4183
4184 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4185 return 1;
4186 }
4187
4188 return 0;
4189 }
4190
4191 int
4192 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
4193 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4194 {
4195 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4196
4197 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4198 {
4199 struct bp_location *loc;
4200
4201 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4202 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4203 continue;
4204
4205 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4206 continue;
4207
4208 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4209 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4210 {
4211 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4212
4213 /* Check for intersection. */
4214 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4215 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4216 if (l < h)
4217 return 1;
4218 }
4219 }
4220 return 0;
4221 }
4222 \f
4223
4224 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4225 in breakpoint.h. */
4226
4227 int
4228 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4229 {
4230 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4231 }
4232
4233 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4234 'next' chain. */
4235
4236 bpstats::~bpstats ()
4237 {
4238 if (old_val != NULL)
4239 value_free (old_val);
4240 if (bp_location_at != NULL)
4241 decref_bp_location (&bp_location_at);
4242 }
4243
4244 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4245 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4246
4247 void
4248 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4249 {
4250 bpstat p;
4251 bpstat q;
4252
4253 if (bsp == 0)
4254 return;
4255 p = *bsp;
4256 while (p != NULL)
4257 {
4258 q = p->next;
4259 delete p;
4260 p = q;
4261 }
4262 *bsp = NULL;
4263 }
4264
4265 bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats &other)
4266 : next (NULL),
4267 bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
4268 breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
4269 commands (other.commands),
4270 old_val (other.old_val),
4271 print (other.print),
4272 stop (other.stop),
4273 print_it (other.print_it)
4274 {
4275 if (old_val != NULL)
4276 {
4277 old_val = value_copy (old_val);
4278 release_value (old_val);
4279 }
4280 incref_bp_location (bp_location_at);
4281 }
4282
4283 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4284 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4285
4286 bpstat
4287 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4288 {
4289 bpstat p = NULL;
4290 bpstat tmp;
4291 bpstat retval = NULL;
4292
4293 if (bs == NULL)
4294 return bs;
4295
4296 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4297 {
4298 tmp = new bpstats (*bs);
4299
4300 if (p == NULL)
4301 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4302 retval = tmp;
4303 else
4304 p->next = tmp;
4305 p = tmp;
4306 }
4307 p->next = NULL;
4308 return retval;
4309 }
4310
4311 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4312
4313 bpstat
4314 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4315 {
4316 if (bsp == NULL)
4317 return NULL;
4318
4319 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4320 {
4321 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4322 return bsp;
4323 }
4324 return NULL;
4325 }
4326
4327 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4328
4329 int
4330 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4331 {
4332 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4333 {
4334 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4335 {
4336 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4337 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4338 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4339 return 1;
4340 }
4341 else
4342 {
4343 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4344 sig))
4345 return 1;
4346 }
4347 }
4348
4349 return 0;
4350 }
4351
4352 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4353 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4354 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4355 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4356
4357 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4358 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4359 we set it.
4360 Return 1 otherwise. */
4361
4362 int
4363 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4364 {
4365 struct breakpoint *b;
4366
4367 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4368 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4369
4370 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4371 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4372 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4373 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4374 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4375 if (b == NULL)
4376 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4377
4378 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4379 return 1;
4380 }
4381
4382 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4383
4384 void
4385 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4386 {
4387 struct thread_info *tp;
4388 bpstat bs;
4389
4390 if (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4391 return;
4392
4393 tp = find_thread_ptid (inferior_ptid);
4394 if (tp == NULL)
4395 return;
4396
4397 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4398 {
4399 bs->commands = NULL;
4400
4401 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4402 {
4403 value_free (bs->old_val);
4404 bs->old_val = NULL;
4405 }
4406 }
4407 }
4408
4409 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4410
4411 static void
4412 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4413 {
4414 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4415 {
4416 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4417
4418 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4419 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4420 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4421 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4422 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4423 return;
4424 }
4425
4426 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4427 }
4428
4429 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4430 or its equivalent. */
4431
4432 static int
4433 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4434 {
4435 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4436 }
4437
4438 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4439 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4440 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4441 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4442
4443 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4444 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4445 bpstat of the current thread. */
4446
4447 static int
4448 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4449 {
4450 bpstat bs;
4451 int again = 0;
4452
4453 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4454 in bs->commands. */
4455 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4456 return 0;
4457
4458 scoped_restore save_executing
4459 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
4460
4461 scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
4462
4463 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4464 bs = *bsp;
4465
4466 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4467 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4468 {
4469 struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
4470
4471 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4472
4473 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4474 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4475 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4476 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4477 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4478 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4479 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4480 the tree when we're done. */
4481 counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
4482 bs->commands = NULL;
4483 if (ccmd != NULL)
4484 cmd = ccmd.get ();
4485 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4486 {
4487 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4488 cmd = cmd->next;
4489 }
4490
4491 while (cmd != NULL)
4492 {
4493 execute_control_command (cmd);
4494
4495 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4496 break;
4497 else
4498 cmd = cmd->next;
4499 }
4500
4501 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4502 {
4503 if (current_ui->async)
4504 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4505 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4506 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4507 ;
4508 else
4509 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4510 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4511 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4512 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4513 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4514 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4515 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4516 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4517 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4518 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4519 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4520 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4521 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4522 again = 1;
4523 break;
4524 }
4525 }
4526 return again;
4527 }
4528
4529 void
4530 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4531 {
4532 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4533
4534 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4535 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
4536 && target_has_execution
4537 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
4538 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
4539 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
4540 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
4541 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
4542 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4543 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat))
4544 break;
4545
4546 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4547 }
4548
4549 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4550
4551 static void
4552 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4553 {
4554 if (val == NULL)
4555 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4556 else
4557 {
4558 struct value_print_options opts;
4559 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4560 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4561 }
4562 }
4563
4564 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4565 debugging multiple threads. */
4566
4567 void
4568 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4569 {
4570 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4571 return;
4572
4573 uiout->text ("\n");
4574
4575 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4576 {
4577 const char *name;
4578 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4579
4580 uiout->text ("Thread ");
4581 uiout->field_fmt ("thread-id", "%s", print_thread_id (thr));
4582
4583 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4584 if (name != NULL)
4585 {
4586 uiout->text (" \"");
4587 uiout->field_fmt ("name", "%s", name);
4588 uiout->text ("\"");
4589 }
4590
4591 uiout->text (" hit ");
4592 }
4593 }
4594
4595 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4596 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4597 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4598 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4599 normal_stop(). */
4600
4601 static enum print_stop_action
4602 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4603 {
4604 switch (bs->print_it)
4605 {
4606 case print_it_noop:
4607 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4608 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4609 break;
4610
4611 case print_it_done:
4612 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4613 relevant messages. */
4614 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4615 break;
4616
4617 case print_it_normal:
4618 {
4619 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4620
4621 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4622 which has since been deleted. */
4623 if (b == NULL)
4624 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4625
4626 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4627 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4628 }
4629 break;
4630
4631 default:
4632 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4633 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4634 break;
4635 }
4636 }
4637
4638 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4639
4640 static void
4641 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4642 {
4643 int any_deleted
4644 = !VEC_empty (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs);
4645 int any_added
4646 = !VEC_empty (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs);
4647
4648 if (!is_catchpoint)
4649 {
4650 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4651 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4652 else
4653 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4654 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4655 }
4656
4657 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4658 current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
4659 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4660
4661 if (any_deleted)
4662 {
4663 char *name;
4664 int ix;
4665
4666 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4667 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
4668 for (ix = 0;
4669 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
4670 ix, name);
4671 ++ix)
4672 {
4673 if (ix > 0)
4674 current_uiout->text (" ");
4675 current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
4676 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4677 }
4678 }
4679
4680 if (any_added)
4681 {
4682 struct so_list *iter;
4683 int ix;
4684
4685 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4686 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
4687 for (ix = 0;
4688 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
4689 ix, iter);
4690 ++ix)
4691 {
4692 if (ix > 0)
4693 current_uiout->text (" ");
4694 current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
4695 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4696 }
4697 }
4698 }
4699
4700 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4701 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4702 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4703 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4704 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4705 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4706 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4707 routine is one of:
4708
4709 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4710 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4711 code to print the location. An example is
4712 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4713 the location.
4714 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4715 to also print the location part of the message.
4716 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4717 don't require a location appended to the end.
4718 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4719 further info to be printed. */
4720
4721 enum print_stop_action
4722 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4723 {
4724 enum print_stop_action val;
4725
4726 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4727 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4728 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4729 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4730 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4731 {
4732 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4733 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4734 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4735 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4736 return val;
4737 }
4738
4739 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4740 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4741 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4742 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4743 {
4744 print_solib_event (0);
4745 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4746 }
4747
4748 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4749 with and nothing was printed. */
4750 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4751 }
4752
4753 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4754
4755 static bool
4756 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
4757 {
4758 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4759 bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
4760
4761 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4762 return res;
4763 }
4764
4765 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4766
4767 bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4768 : next (NULL),
4769 bp_location_at (bl),
4770 breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
4771 commands (NULL),
4772 old_val (NULL),
4773 print (0),
4774 stop (0),
4775 print_it (print_it_normal)
4776 {
4777 incref_bp_location (bl);
4778 **bs_link_pointer = this;
4779 *bs_link_pointer = &next;
4780 }
4781
4782 bpstats::bpstats ()
4783 : next (NULL),
4784 bp_location_at (NULL),
4785 breakpoint_at (NULL),
4786 commands (NULL),
4787 old_val (NULL),
4788 print (0),
4789 stop (0),
4790 print_it (print_it_normal)
4791 {
4792 }
4793 \f
4794 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4795 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4796
4797 int
4798 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4799 {
4800 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4801 CORE_ADDR addr;
4802 struct breakpoint *b;
4803
4804 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4805 {
4806 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4807 as not triggered. */
4808 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4809 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4810 {
4811 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4812
4813 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4814 }
4815
4816 return 0;
4817 }
4818
4819 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
4820 {
4821 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4822 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4823 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4824 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4825 {
4826 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4827
4828 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4829 }
4830
4831 return 1;
4832 }
4833
4834 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4835 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4836 triggered. */
4837
4838 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4839 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4840 {
4841 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4842 struct bp_location *loc;
4843
4844 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4845 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4846 {
4847 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4848 {
4849 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4850 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4851
4852 if (newaddr == start)
4853 {
4854 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4855 break;
4856 }
4857 }
4858 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4859 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
4860 addr, loc->address,
4861 loc->length))
4862 {
4863 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4864 break;
4865 }
4866 }
4867 }
4868
4869 return 1;
4870 }
4871
4872 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4873 enum wp_check_result
4874 {
4875 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4876 WP_DELETED = 1,
4877
4878 /* The value has changed. */
4879 WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
4880
4881 /* The value has not changed. */
4882 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
4883
4884 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4885 WP_IGNORE = 4,
4886 };
4887
4888 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4889 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4890
4891 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4892 changed. */
4893
4894 static wp_check_result
4895 watchpoint_check (bpstat bs)
4896 {
4897 struct watchpoint *b;
4898 struct frame_info *fr;
4899 int within_current_scope;
4900
4901 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4902 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4903 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4904
4905 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4906 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4907 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4908 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4909 return WP_IGNORE;
4910
4911 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4912 within_current_scope = 1;
4913 else
4914 {
4915 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4916 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4917 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4918
4919 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4920 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4921 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4922 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4923 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4924 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4925 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4926 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4927 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4928 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4929 return WP_IGNORE;
4930
4931 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4932 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4933
4934 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4935 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4936 if (within_current_scope)
4937 {
4938 struct symbol *function;
4939
4940 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4941 if (function == NULL
4942 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
4943 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
4944 within_current_scope = 0;
4945 }
4946
4947 if (within_current_scope)
4948 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4949 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4950 the user. */
4951 select_frame (fr);
4952 }
4953
4954 if (within_current_scope)
4955 {
4956 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4957 time before we return to the command level and call
4958 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4959 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4960
4961 int pc = 0;
4962 struct value *mark;
4963 struct value *new_val;
4964
4965 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4966 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4967 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4968 a mask watchpoint. */
4969 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4970
4971 mark = value_mark ();
4972 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
4973
4974 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
4975 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
4976
4977 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4978 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4979 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4980 not what we want. */
4981 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4982 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
4983 {
4984 if (new_val != NULL)
4985 {
4986 release_value (new_val);
4987 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4988 }
4989 bs->old_val = b->val;
4990 b->val = new_val;
4991 b->val_valid = 1;
4992 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4993 }
4994 else
4995 {
4996 /* Nothing changed. */
4997 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4998 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4999 }
5000 }
5001 else
5002 {
5003 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
5004 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
5005 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
5006 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
5007 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
5008 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
5009 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
5010 the first value assigned). */
5011 /* We print all the stop information in
5012 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
5013 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
5014 already. So we have no choice but print the information
5015 here. */
5016
5017 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5018 {
5019 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5020
5021 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5022 uiout->field_string
5023 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
5024 uiout->text ("\nWatchpoint ");
5025 uiout->field_int ("wpnum", b->number);
5026 uiout->text (" deleted because the program has left the block in\n"
5027 "which its expression is valid.\n");
5028 }
5029
5030 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
5031 b->commands = NULL;
5032 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5033
5034 return WP_DELETED;
5035 }
5036 }
5037
5038 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
5039 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
5040 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
5041
5042 static int
5043 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
5044 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5045 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5046 {
5047 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
5048
5049 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
5050 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5051
5052 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5053 }
5054
5055 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
5056 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
5057
5058 static void
5059 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
5060 {
5061 const struct bp_location *bl;
5062 struct watchpoint *b;
5063
5064 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5065 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5066 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5067 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5068 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5069
5070 {
5071 int must_check_value = 0;
5072
5073 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5074 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5075 watched value. */
5076 must_check_value = 1;
5077 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5078 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5079 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5080 this watchpoint. */
5081 must_check_value = 1;
5082 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5083 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5084 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5085 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5086 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5087 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5088 must_check_value = 1;
5089
5090 if (must_check_value)
5091 {
5092 wp_check_result e;
5093
5094 TRY
5095 {
5096 e = watchpoint_check (bs);
5097 }
5098 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5099 {
5100 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5101 "Error evaluating expression "
5102 "for watchpoint %d\n",
5103 b->number);
5104
5105 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5106 {
5107 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5108 b->number);
5109 }
5110 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5111 e = WP_DELETED;
5112 }
5113 END_CATCH
5114
5115 switch (e)
5116 {
5117 case WP_DELETED:
5118 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5119 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5120 /* Stop. */
5121 break;
5122 case WP_IGNORE:
5123 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5124 bs->stop = 0;
5125 break;
5126 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5127 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5128 {
5129 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5130
5131 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5132 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5133 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5134 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5135 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5136 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5137 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5138 old value.
5139
5140 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5141 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5142 happen:
5143
5144 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5145 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5146 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5147 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5148
5149 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5150 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5151 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5152 watchpoint.
5153
5154 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5155 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5156 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5157 changes. This still gives false positives when
5158 the program writes the same value to memory as
5159 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5160 it for a read), but it's much better than
5161 nothing. */
5162
5163 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5164
5165 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5166 {
5167 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5168
5169 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5170 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5171 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5172 {
5173 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5174 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5175
5176 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5177 == watch_triggered_yes)
5178 {
5179 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5180 break;
5181 }
5182 }
5183 }
5184
5185 if (other_write_watchpoint
5186 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5187 {
5188 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5189 and the value changed since the last time we
5190 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5191 Ignore it. */
5192 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5193 bs->stop = 0;
5194 }
5195 }
5196 break;
5197 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5198 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5199 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5200 {
5201 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5202 the value hasn't changed. */
5203 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5204 bs->stop = 0;
5205 }
5206 /* Stop. */
5207 break;
5208 default:
5209 /* Can't happen. */
5210 break;
5211 }
5212 }
5213 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5214 {
5215 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5216 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5217 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5218 anything for this watchpoint. */
5219 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5220 bs->stop = 0;
5221 }
5222 }
5223 }
5224
5225 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5226 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5227 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5228 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5229
5230 static void
5231 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
5232 {
5233 const struct bp_location *bl;
5234 struct breakpoint *b;
5235 /* Assume stop. */
5236 bool condition_result = true;
5237 struct expression *cond;
5238
5239 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5240
5241 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5242 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5243 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5244 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5245 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5246
5247 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5248 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5249 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5250
5251 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5252 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5253 {
5254 bs->stop = 0;
5255 return;
5256 }
5257
5258 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5259 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5260 thread/task. */
5261 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != ptid_to_global_thread_id (ptid))
5262 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (ptid)))
5263
5264 {
5265 bs->stop = 0;
5266 return;
5267 }
5268
5269 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5270 implemented. */
5271 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5272
5273 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5274 {
5275 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5276
5277 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5278 }
5279 else
5280 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5281
5282 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5283 {
5284 int within_current_scope = 1;
5285 struct watchpoint * w;
5286
5287 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5288 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5289 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5290 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5291 function call. */
5292 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5293
5294 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5295 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5296 else
5297 w = NULL;
5298
5299 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5300 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5301 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5302 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5303 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5304 call site. */
5305 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5306 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5307 else
5308 {
5309 struct frame_info *frame;
5310
5311 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5312 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5313 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5314 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5315 really matter which instantiation of the function
5316 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5317 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5318 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5319 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5320 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5321 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5322 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5323 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5324 intuitive. */
5325 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5326 if (frame != NULL)
5327 select_frame (frame);
5328 else
5329 within_current_scope = 0;
5330 }
5331 if (within_current_scope)
5332 {
5333 TRY
5334 {
5335 condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
5336 }
5337 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5338 {
5339 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5340 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5341 }
5342 END_CATCH
5343 }
5344 else
5345 {
5346 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5347 "in the current scope"));
5348 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5349 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5350 }
5351 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5352 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5353 }
5354
5355 if (cond && !condition_result)
5356 {
5357 bs->stop = 0;
5358 }
5359 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5360 {
5361 b->ignore_count--;
5362 bs->stop = 0;
5363 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5364 ++(b->hit_count);
5365 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5366 }
5367 }
5368
5369 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5370 on the current target. */
5371
5372 static int
5373 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5374 {
5375 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5376 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5377 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5378 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5379 }
5380
5381
5382 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
5383 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
5384
5385 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
5386 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such
5387 that:
5388
5389 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
5390
5391 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
5392
5393 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
5394 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
5395 several reasons concurrently.)
5396
5397 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
5398 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
5399
5400 bpstat
5401 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
5402 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid,
5403 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5404 {
5405 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5406 struct bp_location *bl;
5407 struct bp_location *loc;
5408 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5409 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5410 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
5411 bpstat bs;
5412 int ix;
5413 int need_remove_insert;
5414 int removed_any;
5415
5416 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5417 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5418 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5419 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5420 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5421 inferior function calls. */
5422
5423 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5424 {
5425 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5426 continue;
5427
5428 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5429 {
5430 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5431 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5432 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5433 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5434 checked all locations already. */
5435 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5436 break;
5437
5438 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5439 continue;
5440
5441 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5442 continue;
5443
5444 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5445 matches. */
5446
5447 bs = new bpstats (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5448 explain stop. */
5449
5450 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5451 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5452 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5453 bs->stop = 1;
5454 bs->print = 1;
5455
5456 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5457 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5458 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5459 iteration. */
5460 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5461 {
5462 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5463
5464 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5465 }
5466 }
5467 }
5468
5469 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5470 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5471 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5472 {
5473 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
5474 {
5475 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5476 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5477 {
5478 bs = new bpstats (loc, &bs_link);
5479 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5480 bs->stop = 0;
5481 bs->print = 0;
5482 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5483 }
5484 }
5485 }
5486
5487 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5488 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5489 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5490 "catch unload". */
5491 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5492 {
5493 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5494 {
5495 handle_solib_event ();
5496 break;
5497 }
5498 }
5499
5500 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5501 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5502 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5503
5504 removed_any = 0;
5505
5506 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5507 {
5508 if (!bs->stop)
5509 continue;
5510
5511 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5512 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5513 if (bs->stop)
5514 {
5515 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
5516
5517 if (bs->stop)
5518 {
5519 ++(b->hit_count);
5520 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5521
5522 /* We will stop here. */
5523 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5524 {
5525 --(b->enable_count);
5526 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5527 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5528 removed_any = 1;
5529 }
5530 if (b->silent)
5531 bs->print = 0;
5532 bs->commands = b->commands;
5533 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5534 ? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
5535 bs->print = 0;
5536
5537 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5538 }
5539
5540 }
5541
5542 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5543 print. */
5544 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5545 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5546 }
5547
5548 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5549 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5550 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5551 done later. */
5552 need_remove_insert = 0;
5553 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5554 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5555 if (!bs->stop
5556 && bs->breakpoint_at
5557 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5558 {
5559 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5560
5561 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5562 need_remove_insert = 1;
5563 }
5564
5565 if (need_remove_insert)
5566 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5567 else if (removed_any)
5568 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5569
5570 return bs_head;
5571 }
5572
5573 static void
5574 handle_jit_event (void)
5575 {
5576 struct frame_info *frame;
5577 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5578
5579 if (debug_infrun)
5580 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n");
5581
5582 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5583 breakpoint_re_set. */
5584 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5585
5586 frame = get_current_frame ();
5587 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5588
5589 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5590
5591 target_terminal::inferior ();
5592 }
5593
5594 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5595
5596 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5597
5598 struct bpstat_what
5599 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5600 {
5601 struct bpstat_what retval;
5602 bpstat bs;
5603
5604 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5605 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5606 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5607
5608 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5609 {
5610 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5611 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5612 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5613 enum bptype bptype;
5614
5615 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5616 {
5617 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5618 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5619 bptype = bp_none;
5620 }
5621 else
5622 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5623
5624 switch (bptype)
5625 {
5626 case bp_none:
5627 break;
5628 case bp_breakpoint:
5629 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5630 case bp_single_step:
5631 case bp_until:
5632 case bp_finish:
5633 case bp_shlib_event:
5634 if (bs->stop)
5635 {
5636 if (bs->print)
5637 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5638 else
5639 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5640 }
5641 else
5642 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5643 break;
5644 case bp_watchpoint:
5645 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5646 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5647 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5648 if (bs->stop)
5649 {
5650 if (bs->print)
5651 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5652 else
5653 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5654 }
5655 else
5656 {
5657 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5658 This requires no further action. */
5659 }
5660 break;
5661 case bp_longjmp:
5662 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5663 case bp_exception:
5664 if (bs->stop)
5665 {
5666 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5667 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5668 }
5669 else
5670 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5671 break;
5672 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5673 case bp_exception_resume:
5674 if (bs->stop)
5675 {
5676 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5677 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5678 }
5679 else
5680 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5681 break;
5682 case bp_step_resume:
5683 if (bs->stop)
5684 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5685 else
5686 {
5687 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5688 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5689 }
5690 break;
5691 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5692 if (bs->stop)
5693 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5694 else
5695 {
5696 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5697 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5698 }
5699 break;
5700 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5701 case bp_thread_event:
5702 case bp_overlay_event:
5703 case bp_longjmp_master:
5704 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5705 case bp_exception_master:
5706 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5707 break;
5708 case bp_catchpoint:
5709 if (bs->stop)
5710 {
5711 if (bs->print)
5712 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5713 else
5714 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5715 }
5716 else
5717 {
5718 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5719 This requires no further action. */
5720 }
5721 break;
5722 case bp_jit_event:
5723 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5724 break;
5725 case bp_call_dummy:
5726 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5727 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5728 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5729 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5730 break;
5731 case bp_std_terminate:
5732 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5733 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5734 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5735 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5736 break;
5737 case bp_tracepoint:
5738 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5739 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5740 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5741 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5742 out already. */
5743 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5744 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5745 break;
5746 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5747 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5748 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5749 break;
5750 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5751 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5752 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5753 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5754 break;
5755
5756 case bp_dprintf:
5757 if (bs->stop)
5758 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5759 else
5760 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5761 break;
5762
5763 default:
5764 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5765 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5766 }
5767
5768 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5769 }
5770
5771 return retval;
5772 }
5773
5774 void
5775 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
5776 {
5777 bpstat bs;
5778
5779 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5780 {
5781 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5782
5783 if (b == NULL)
5784 continue;
5785 switch (b->type)
5786 {
5787 case bp_jit_event:
5788 handle_jit_event ();
5789 break;
5790 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5791 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5792 break;
5793 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5794 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5795 break;
5796 }
5797 }
5798 }
5799
5800 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5801 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5802 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5803
5804 int
5805 bpstat_should_step (void)
5806 {
5807 struct breakpoint *b;
5808
5809 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5810 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5811 return 1;
5812 return 0;
5813 }
5814
5815 int
5816 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5817 {
5818 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5819 if (bs->stop)
5820 return 1;
5821
5822 return 0;
5823 }
5824
5825 \f
5826
5827 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5828 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5829 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5830
5831 static char *
5832 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5833 {
5834 static char wrap_indent[80];
5835 int i, total_width, width, align;
5836 const char *text;
5837
5838 total_width = 0;
5839 for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5840 {
5841 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5842 {
5843 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5844 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5845 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5846
5847 return wrap_indent;
5848 }
5849
5850 total_width += width + 1;
5851 }
5852
5853 return NULL;
5854 }
5855
5856 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5857 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5858
5859 "host": Host evals condition.
5860 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5861 "target": Target evals condition.
5862 */
5863
5864 static const char *
5865 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5866 {
5867 struct bp_location *bl;
5868 char host_evals = 0;
5869 char target_evals = 0;
5870
5871 if (!b)
5872 return NULL;
5873
5874 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5875 return NULL;
5876
5877 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5878 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5879 return condition_evaluation_host;
5880
5881 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5882 {
5883 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5884 target_evals++;
5885 else
5886 host_evals++;
5887 }
5888
5889 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5890 return condition_evaluation_both;
5891 else if (target_evals)
5892 return condition_evaluation_target;
5893 else
5894 return condition_evaluation_host;
5895 }
5896
5897 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5898 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5899
5900 static const char *
5901 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5902 {
5903 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5904 return NULL;
5905
5906 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5907 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5908 return condition_evaluation_host;
5909
5910 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5911 return condition_evaluation_target;
5912 else
5913 return condition_evaluation_host;
5914 }
5915
5916 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5917
5918 static void
5919 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5920 struct bp_location *loc)
5921 {
5922 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5923
5924 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
5925
5926 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5927 loc = NULL;
5928
5929 if (loc != NULL)
5930 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5931
5932 if (b->display_canonical)
5933 uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5934 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5935 {
5936 const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
5937
5938 if (sym == NULL)
5939 sym = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
5940
5941 if (sym)
5942 {
5943 uiout->text ("in ");
5944 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
5945 uiout->text (" ");
5946 uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5947 uiout->text ("at ");
5948 }
5949 uiout->field_string ("file",
5950 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab));
5951 uiout->text (":");
5952
5953 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5954 uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5955
5956 uiout->field_int ("line", loc->line_number);
5957 }
5958 else if (loc)
5959 {
5960 string_file stb;
5961
5962 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
5963 demangle, "");
5964 uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
5965 }
5966 else
5967 {
5968 uiout->field_string ("pending",
5969 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5970 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5971 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5972 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5973 if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
5974 {
5975 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
5976 uiout->text (",");
5977 else
5978 uiout->text (" ");
5979 uiout->text (b->extra_string);
5980 }
5981 }
5982
5983 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5984 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5985 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5986 {
5987 uiout->text (" (");
5988 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5989 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5990 uiout->text (")");
5991 }
5992 }
5993
5994 static const char *
5995 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5996 {
5997 struct ep_type_description
5998 {
5999 enum bptype type;
6000 const char *description;
6001 };
6002 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
6003 {
6004 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
6005 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
6006 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
6007 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
6008 {bp_until, "until"},
6009 {bp_finish, "finish"},
6010 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
6011 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
6012 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
6013 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
6014 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
6015 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
6016 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
6017 {bp_exception, "exception"},
6018 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
6019 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
6020 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
6021 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
6022 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
6023 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
6024 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
6025 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
6026 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
6027 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
6028 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
6029 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
6030 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
6031 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
6032 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
6033 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
6034 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
6035 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
6036 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
6037 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
6038 };
6039
6040 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
6041 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
6042 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6043 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
6044 (int) type);
6045
6046 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
6047 }
6048
6049 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
6050 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
6051
6052 static void
6053 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
6054 const char *field_name,
6055 VEC(int) *inf_num,
6056 int mi_only)
6057 {
6058 int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
6059 int inf;
6060 int i;
6061
6062 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6063 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
6064 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
6065 return;
6066
6067 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
6068
6069 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (int, inf_num, i, inf); ++i)
6070 {
6071 if (is_mi)
6072 {
6073 char mi_group[10];
6074
6075 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf);
6076 uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
6077 }
6078 else
6079 {
6080 if (i == 0)
6081 uiout->text (" inf ");
6082 else
6083 uiout->text (", ");
6084
6085 uiout->text (plongest (inf));
6086 }
6087 }
6088 }
6089
6090 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6091
6092 static void
6093 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6094 struct bp_location *loc,
6095 int loc_number,
6096 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6097 int allflag)
6098 {
6099 struct command_line *l;
6100 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6101
6102 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6103 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6104 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6105 struct value_print_options opts;
6106
6107 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6108
6109 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6110 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6111 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6112 if (loc == NULL
6113 && (b->loc != NULL
6114 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6115 header_of_multiple = 1;
6116 if (loc == NULL)
6117 loc = b->loc;
6118
6119 annotate_record ();
6120
6121 /* 1 */
6122 annotate_field (0);
6123 if (part_of_multiple)
6124 {
6125 char *formatted;
6126 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6127 uiout->field_string ("number", formatted);
6128 xfree (formatted);
6129 }
6130 else
6131 {
6132 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
6133 }
6134
6135 /* 2 */
6136 annotate_field (1);
6137 if (part_of_multiple)
6138 uiout->field_skip ("type");
6139 else
6140 uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
6141
6142 /* 3 */
6143 annotate_field (2);
6144 if (part_of_multiple)
6145 uiout->field_skip ("disp");
6146 else
6147 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6148
6149
6150 /* 4 */
6151 annotate_field (3);
6152 if (part_of_multiple)
6153 uiout->field_string ("enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6154 else
6155 uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6156 uiout->spaces (2);
6157
6158
6159 /* 5 and 6 */
6160 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6161 {
6162 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6163 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6164 make sure there's just one location. */
6165 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6166 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6167 }
6168 else
6169 switch (b->type)
6170 {
6171 case bp_none:
6172 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6173 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6174 break;
6175
6176 case bp_watchpoint:
6177 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6178 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6179 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6180 {
6181 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6182
6183 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6184 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6185 is relatively readable). */
6186 if (opts.addressprint)
6187 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
6188 annotate_field (5);
6189 uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string);
6190 }
6191 break;
6192
6193 case bp_breakpoint:
6194 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6195 case bp_single_step:
6196 case bp_until:
6197 case bp_finish:
6198 case bp_longjmp:
6199 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6200 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6201 case bp_exception:
6202 case bp_exception_resume:
6203 case bp_step_resume:
6204 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6205 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6206 case bp_call_dummy:
6207 case bp_std_terminate:
6208 case bp_shlib_event:
6209 case bp_thread_event:
6210 case bp_overlay_event:
6211 case bp_longjmp_master:
6212 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6213 case bp_exception_master:
6214 case bp_tracepoint:
6215 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6216 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6217 case bp_dprintf:
6218 case bp_jit_event:
6219 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6220 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6221 if (opts.addressprint)
6222 {
6223 annotate_field (4);
6224 if (header_of_multiple)
6225 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6226 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6227 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>");
6228 else
6229 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
6230 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6231 }
6232 annotate_field (5);
6233 if (!header_of_multiple)
6234 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6235 if (b->loc)
6236 *last_loc = b->loc;
6237 break;
6238 }
6239
6240
6241 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6242 {
6243 struct inferior *inf;
6244 VEC(int) *inf_num = NULL;
6245 int mi_only = 1;
6246
6247 ALL_INFERIORS (inf)
6248 {
6249 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6250 VEC_safe_push (int, inf_num, inf->num);
6251 }
6252
6253 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6254 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6255 if (allflag
6256 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6257 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6258 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6259 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6260 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6261 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6262 mi_only = 0;
6263 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_num, mi_only);
6264 VEC_free (int, inf_num);
6265 }
6266
6267 if (!part_of_multiple)
6268 {
6269 if (b->thread != -1)
6270 {
6271 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6272 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6273 uiout->text (" thread ");
6274 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6275 }
6276 else if (b->task != 0)
6277 {
6278 uiout->text (" task ");
6279 uiout->field_int ("task", b->task);
6280 }
6281 }
6282
6283 uiout->text ("\n");
6284
6285 if (!part_of_multiple)
6286 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6287
6288 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6289 {
6290 annotate_field (6);
6291 uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6292 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6293 the frame ID. */
6294 uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
6295 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6296 uiout->text ("\n");
6297 }
6298
6299 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6300 {
6301 annotate_field (7);
6302 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6303 uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6304 else
6305 uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
6306 uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string);
6307
6308 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6309 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6310 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6311 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6312 == condition_evaluation_target)
6313 {
6314 uiout->text (" (");
6315 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
6316 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6317 uiout->text (" evals)");
6318 }
6319 uiout->text ("\n");
6320 }
6321
6322 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6323 {
6324 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6325 uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6326 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6327 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6328 else
6329 {
6330 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6331
6332 uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6333 }
6334 uiout->text ("\n");
6335 }
6336
6337 if (!part_of_multiple)
6338 {
6339 if (b->hit_count)
6340 {
6341 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6342 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6343 uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6344 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6345 uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
6346 else
6347 uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6348 uiout->text (" already hit ");
6349 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6350 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6351 uiout->text (" time\n");
6352 else
6353 uiout->text (" times\n");
6354 }
6355 else
6356 {
6357 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6358 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6359 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6360 }
6361 }
6362
6363 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6364 {
6365 annotate_field (8);
6366 uiout->text ("\tignore next ");
6367 uiout->field_int ("ignore", b->ignore_count);
6368 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6369 }
6370
6371 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6372 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6373 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6374 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6375 {
6376 annotate_field (8);
6377 uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
6378 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6379 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6380 if (b->ignore_count)
6381 uiout->text ("additional ");
6382 else
6383 uiout->text ("next ");
6384 uiout->field_int ("enable", b->enable_count);
6385 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6386 }
6387
6388 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6389 {
6390 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6391
6392 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6393 {
6394 uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6395 uiout->field_int ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6396 uiout->text (" bytes\n");
6397 }
6398 }
6399
6400 l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
6401 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6402 {
6403 annotate_field (9);
6404 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
6405 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6406 }
6407
6408 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6409 {
6410 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6411
6412 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6413 {
6414 annotate_field (10);
6415 uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
6416 uiout->field_int ("pass", t->pass_count);
6417 uiout->text (" \n");
6418 }
6419
6420 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6421 pending. */
6422 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6423 {
6424 annotate_field (11);
6425
6426 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6427 uiout->field_string ("installed",
6428 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6429 else
6430 {
6431 if (loc->inserted)
6432 uiout->text ("\t");
6433 else
6434 uiout->text ("\tnot ");
6435 uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
6436 }
6437 }
6438 }
6439
6440 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
6441 {
6442 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6443 {
6444 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6445
6446 uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string);
6447 }
6448 else if (b->location != NULL
6449 && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
6450 uiout->field_string ("original-location",
6451 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
6452 }
6453 }
6454
6455 static void
6456 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6457 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6458 int allflag)
6459 {
6460 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6461
6462 {
6463 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "bkpt");
6464
6465 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6466 }
6467
6468 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6469 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6470 locations, if any. */
6471 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6472 {
6473 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6474 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6475 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6476 situation.
6477
6478 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6479 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6480 if (b->loc
6481 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6482 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6483 {
6484 struct bp_location *loc;
6485 int n = 1;
6486
6487 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6488 {
6489 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
6490 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6491 }
6492 }
6493 }
6494 }
6495
6496 static int
6497 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6498 {
6499 int print_address_bits = 0;
6500 struct bp_location *loc;
6501
6502 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6503 address to print. */
6504 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6505 return 0;
6506
6507 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6508 {
6509 int addr_bit;
6510
6511 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6512 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6513 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6514 }
6515
6516 return print_address_bits;
6517 }
6518
6519 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6520
6521 void
6522 print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
6523 {
6524 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6525 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6526 }
6527
6528 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6529 internal or momentary. */
6530
6531 int
6532 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6533 {
6534 return b->number > 0;
6535 }
6536
6537 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6538
6539 int
6540 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6541 {
6542 return b->loc == NULL;
6543 }
6544
6545 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6546 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6547 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6548 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6549 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6550 breakpoints listed. */
6551
6552 static int
6553 breakpoint_1 (const char *args, int allflag,
6554 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6555 {
6556 struct breakpoint *b;
6557 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6558 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6559 struct value_print_options opts;
6560 int print_address_bits = 0;
6561 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6562 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6563
6564 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6565
6566 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6567 required for address fields. */
6568 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6569 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6570 {
6571 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6572 if (filter && !filter (b))
6573 continue;
6574
6575 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6576 accept. Skip the others. */
6577 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6578 {
6579 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6580 continue;
6581 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6582 continue;
6583 }
6584
6585 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6586 {
6587 int addr_bit, type_len;
6588
6589 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6590 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6591 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6592
6593 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6594 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6595 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6596
6597 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6598 }
6599 }
6600
6601 {
6602 ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
6603 opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
6604 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6605 "BreakpointTable");
6606
6607 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6608 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6609 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6610 annotate_field (0);
6611 uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6612 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6613 annotate_field (1);
6614 uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6615 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6616 annotate_field (2);
6617 uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6618 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6619 annotate_field (3);
6620 uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6621 if (opts.addressprint)
6622 {
6623 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6624 annotate_field (4);
6625 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6626 uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6627 else
6628 uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6629 }
6630 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6631 annotate_field (5);
6632 uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6633 uiout->table_body ();
6634 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6635 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6636
6637 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6638 {
6639 QUIT;
6640 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6641 if (filter && !filter (b))
6642 continue;
6643
6644 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6645 accept. Skip the others. */
6646
6647 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6648 {
6649 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6650 {
6651 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6652 continue;
6653 }
6654 else /* all others */
6655 {
6656 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6657 continue;
6658 }
6659 }
6660 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6661 allflag is set. */
6662 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6663 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6664 }
6665 }
6666
6667 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6668 {
6669 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6670 empty list. */
6671 if (!filter)
6672 {
6673 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6674 uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6675 else
6676 uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6677 args);
6678 }
6679 }
6680 else
6681 {
6682 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6683 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6684 }
6685
6686 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6687 there have been breakpoints? */
6688 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6689
6690 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6691 }
6692
6693 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6694 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6695
6696 static void
6697 default_collect_info (void)
6698 {
6699 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6700
6701 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6702 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6703 not wanted. */
6704 if (!*default_collect)
6705 return;
6706
6707 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6708 actions. */
6709 uiout->text ("default collect ");
6710 uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
6711 uiout->text (" \n");
6712 }
6713
6714 static void
6715 info_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
6716 {
6717 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6718
6719 default_collect_info ();
6720 }
6721
6722 static void
6723 info_watchpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
6724 {
6725 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6726 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6727
6728 if (num_printed == 0)
6729 {
6730 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6731 uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6732 else
6733 uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6734 }
6735 }
6736
6737 static void
6738 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
6739 {
6740 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6741
6742 default_collect_info ();
6743 }
6744
6745 static int
6746 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6747 struct program_space *pspace,
6748 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6749 {
6750 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6751
6752 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6753 {
6754 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6755 && bl->address == pc
6756 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6757 return 1;
6758 }
6759 return 0;
6760 }
6761
6762 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6763 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6764 address spaces. */
6765
6766 static void
6767 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6768 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6769 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6770 {
6771 int others = 0;
6772 struct breakpoint *b;
6773
6774 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6775 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6776 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6777 if (others > 0)
6778 {
6779 if (others == 1)
6780 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6781 else /* if (others == ???) */
6782 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6783 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6784 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6785 {
6786 others--;
6787 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6788 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6789 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6790 else if (b->thread != -1)
6791 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6792 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6793 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6794 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6795 ? " (disabled)"
6796 : ""),
6797 (others > 1) ? ","
6798 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6799 }
6800 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6801 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
6802 printf_filtered (".\n");
6803 }
6804 }
6805 \f
6806
6807 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6808 BPT locations. For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members
6809 are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other
6810 addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6811
6812 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6813 always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark
6814 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6815 breakpoint location at address zero:
6816
6817 bp_watchpoint
6818 bp_catchpoint
6819
6820 */
6821
6822 static int
6823 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6824 {
6825 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6826
6827 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6828 }
6829
6830 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6831 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6832
6833 static int
6834 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6835 struct bp_location *loc2)
6836 {
6837 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6838 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6839
6840 /* Both of them must exist. */
6841 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6842 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6843
6844 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6845 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6846 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6847 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6848 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6849 other watchpoint. */
6850 if ((w1->cond_exp
6851 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6852 loc1->length,
6853 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6854 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
6855 || (w2->cond_exp
6856 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6857 loc2->length,
6858 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6859 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
6860 return 0;
6861
6862 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6863 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6864 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6865 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6866 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6867 become hw_access locations later. */
6868 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6869 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6870 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6871 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6872 }
6873
6874 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6875
6876 int
6877 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6878 const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6879 {
6880 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6881 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6882 && addr1 == addr2);
6883 }
6884
6885 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6886 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6887 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6888 space doesn't really matter. */
6889
6890 static int
6891 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
6892 CORE_ADDR addr1,
6893 int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
6894 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6895 {
6896 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6897 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6898 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6899 }
6900
6901 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6902 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6903 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6904 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6905
6906 static int
6907 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6908 const address_space *aspace,
6909 CORE_ADDR addr)
6910 {
6911 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6912 aspace, addr)
6913 || (bl->length
6914 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6915 bl->address, bl->length,
6916 aspace, addr)));
6917 }
6918
6919 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6920 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6921 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6922 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6923 doesn't really matter. */
6924
6925 static int
6926 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
6927 const address_space *aspace,
6928 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
6929 {
6930 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6931 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
6932 {
6933 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
6934
6935 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
6936 return 1;
6937 }
6938 return 0;
6939 }
6940
6941 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6942 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6943 true, otherwise returns false. */
6944
6945 static int
6946 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6947 struct bp_location *loc2)
6948 {
6949 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6950 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6951 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6952 different locations. */
6953 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6954 else
6955 return 0;
6956 }
6957
6958 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6959 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
6960 represent the same location. */
6961
6962 static int
6963 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6964 struct bp_location *loc2)
6965 {
6966 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6967
6968 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6969 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6970 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6971
6972 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6973 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6974
6975 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6976 return 0;
6977 else if (hw_point1)
6978 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6979 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6980 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6981 else
6982 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
6983 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6984 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6985 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6986 }
6987
6988 static void
6989 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6990 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6991 {
6992 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6993 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6994 char astr1[64];
6995 char astr2[64];
6996
6997 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6998 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6999 if (have_bnum)
7000 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
7001 bnum, astr1, astr2);
7002 else
7003 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
7004 }
7005
7006 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
7007 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
7008 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
7009 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
7010
7011 static CORE_ADDR
7012 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7013 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
7014 {
7015 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
7016 {
7017 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
7018 return bpaddr;
7019 }
7020 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
7021 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
7022 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
7023 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
7024 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
7025 {
7026 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
7027 have their addresses modified. */
7028 return bpaddr;
7029 }
7030 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
7031 {
7032 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
7033 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
7034 applies to this address, then it should have already been
7035 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
7036 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
7037 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
7038 return bpaddr;
7039 }
7040 else
7041 {
7042 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
7043
7044 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
7045 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
7046 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
7047
7048 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
7049 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
7050 is required. */
7051 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
7052 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
7053
7054 return adjusted_bpaddr;
7055 }
7056 }
7057
7058 bp_location::bp_location (const bp_location_ops *ops, breakpoint *owner)
7059 {
7060 bp_location *loc = this;
7061
7062 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7063
7064 loc->ops = ops;
7065 loc->owner = owner;
7066 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
7067 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
7068 loc->enabled = 1;
7069
7070 switch (owner->type)
7071 {
7072 case bp_breakpoint:
7073 case bp_single_step:
7074 case bp_until:
7075 case bp_finish:
7076 case bp_longjmp:
7077 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7078 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7079 case bp_exception:
7080 case bp_exception_resume:
7081 case bp_step_resume:
7082 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7083 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7084 case bp_call_dummy:
7085 case bp_std_terminate:
7086 case bp_shlib_event:
7087 case bp_thread_event:
7088 case bp_overlay_event:
7089 case bp_jit_event:
7090 case bp_longjmp_master:
7091 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7092 case bp_exception_master:
7093 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7094 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7095 case bp_dprintf:
7096 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7097 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7098 break;
7099 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7100 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7101 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7102 break;
7103 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7104 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7105 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7106 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7107 break;
7108 case bp_watchpoint:
7109 case bp_catchpoint:
7110 case bp_tracepoint:
7111 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7112 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7113 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7114 break;
7115 default:
7116 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7117 }
7118
7119 loc->refc = 1;
7120 }
7121
7122 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7123
7124 static struct bp_location *
7125 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7126 {
7127 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7128 }
7129
7130 static void
7131 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7132 {
7133 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
7134 delete loc;
7135 }
7136
7137 /* Increment reference count. */
7138
7139 static void
7140 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7141 {
7142 ++bl->refc;
7143 }
7144
7145 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7146 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7147
7148 static void
7149 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7150 {
7151 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7152
7153 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7154 free_bp_location (*blp);
7155 *blp = NULL;
7156 }
7157
7158 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7159
7160 static breakpoint *
7161 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
7162 {
7163 struct breakpoint *b1;
7164 struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
7165
7166 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7167 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7168
7169 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7170 if (b1 == 0)
7171 breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
7172 else
7173 {
7174 while (b1->next)
7175 b1 = b1->next;
7176 b1->next = b.release ();
7177 }
7178
7179 return result;
7180 }
7181
7182 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7183
7184 static void
7185 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7186 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7187 enum bptype bptype,
7188 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7189 {
7190 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7191
7192 b->ops = ops;
7193 b->type = bptype;
7194 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7195 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7196 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7197 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7198 }
7199
7200 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7201 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7202
7203 static struct breakpoint *
7204 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7205 enum bptype bptype,
7206 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7207 {
7208 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7209
7210 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7211 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7212 }
7213
7214 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7215 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7216 enough. */
7217
7218 static void
7219 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7220 {
7221 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7222
7223 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7224 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7225 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7226 {
7227 int is_gnu_ifunc;
7228 const char *function_name;
7229 CORE_ADDR func_addr;
7230
7231 find_pc_partial_function_gnu_ifunc (loc->address, &function_name,
7232 &func_addr, NULL, &is_gnu_ifunc);
7233
7234 if (is_gnu_ifunc && !explicit_loc)
7235 {
7236 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7237
7238 gdb_assert (loc->pspace == current_program_space);
7239 if (gnu_ifunc_resolve_name (function_name,
7240 &loc->requested_address))
7241 {
7242 /* Recalculate ADDRESS based on new REQUESTED_ADDRESS. */
7243 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
7244 loc->requested_address,
7245 b->type);
7246 }
7247 else if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7248 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7249 {
7250 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7251 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7252 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7253 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7254 breakpoint. */
7255 loc->related_address = func_addr;
7256 }
7257 }
7258
7259 if (function_name)
7260 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7261 }
7262 }
7263
7264 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7265 struct gdbarch *
7266 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7267 {
7268 if (sal.section)
7269 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7270 if (sal.symtab)
7271 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7272
7273 return NULL;
7274 }
7275
7276 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7277 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7278 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7279
7280 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7281 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7282 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7283
7284 static void
7285 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7286 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7287 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7288 {
7289 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7290
7291 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7292
7293 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7294 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7295
7296 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7297 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7298 program space. */
7299 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7300 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7301 }
7302
7303 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7304 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7305 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7306 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7307 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7308 is also returned as the value of this function.
7309
7310 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7311 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7312 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7313 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7314 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7315 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7316 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7317
7318 struct breakpoint *
7319 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7320 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7321 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7322 {
7323 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7324
7325 init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7326 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7327 }
7328
7329 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7330 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7331 initiated the operation. */
7332
7333 void
7334 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7335 {
7336 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7337 int thread = tp->global_num;
7338
7339 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7340 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7341 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7342 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7343 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7344 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7345 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7346 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7347 {
7348 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7349 struct breakpoint *clone;
7350
7351 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7352 after their removal. */
7353 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7354 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7355 clone->thread = thread;
7356 }
7357
7358 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7359 }
7360
7361 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7362 void
7363 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7364 {
7365 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7366
7367 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7368 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7369 {
7370 if (b->thread == thread)
7371 delete_breakpoint (b);
7372 }
7373 }
7374
7375 void
7376 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7377 {
7378 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7379
7380 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7381 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7382 {
7383 if (b->thread == thread)
7384 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7385 }
7386 }
7387
7388 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7389 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7390 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7391 breakpoints. */
7392
7393 struct breakpoint *
7394 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7395 {
7396 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7397
7398 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7399 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7400 {
7401 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7402
7403 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7404 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7405 1);
7406 new_b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
7407
7408 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7409
7410 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7411 if (retval == NULL)
7412 retval = new_b;
7413 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7414 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7415 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7416 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7417 }
7418
7419 return retval;
7420 }
7421
7422 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7423 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7424 stack.
7425
7426 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7427 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7428 frames. */
7429
7430 void
7431 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7432 {
7433 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7434
7435 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7436 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7437 {
7438 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7439
7440 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7441 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7442 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7443 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7444 continue;
7445
7446 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp->ptid);
7447
7448 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7449 {
7450 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7451 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7452 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7453 }
7454 delete_breakpoint (b);
7455 }
7456 }
7457
7458 void
7459 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7460 {
7461 struct breakpoint *b;
7462
7463 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7464 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7465 {
7466 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7467 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7468 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7469 }
7470 }
7471
7472 void
7473 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7474 {
7475 struct breakpoint *b;
7476
7477 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7478 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7479 {
7480 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7481 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7482 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7483 }
7484 }
7485
7486 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7487 master breakpoint. */
7488 void
7489 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7490 {
7491 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7492
7493 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7494 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7495 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7496 {
7497 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7498 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7499 }
7500 }
7501
7502 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7503 void
7504 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7505 {
7506 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7507
7508 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7509 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7510 delete_breakpoint (b);
7511 }
7512
7513 struct breakpoint *
7514 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7515 {
7516 struct breakpoint *b;
7517
7518 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7519 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7520
7521 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7522 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7523 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7524
7525 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7526
7527 return b;
7528 }
7529
7530 struct lang_and_radix
7531 {
7532 enum language lang;
7533 int radix;
7534 };
7535
7536 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7537
7538 struct breakpoint *
7539 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7540 {
7541 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7542 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7543 }
7544
7545 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7546
7547 void
7548 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7549 {
7550 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7551
7552 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7553 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7554 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7555 delete_breakpoint (b);
7556 }
7557
7558 void
7559 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7560 {
7561 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7562
7563 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7564 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7565 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7566 delete_breakpoint (b);
7567 }
7568
7569 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7570
7571 void
7572 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7573 {
7574 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7575
7576 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7577 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7578 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7579 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7580 }
7581
7582 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7583 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7584 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7585
7586 static struct breakpoint *
7587 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7588 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7589 {
7590 struct breakpoint *b;
7591
7592 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7593 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7594 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7595 return b;
7596 }
7597
7598 struct breakpoint *
7599 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7600 {
7601 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7602 }
7603
7604 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7605
7606 struct breakpoint *
7607 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7608 {
7609 struct breakpoint *b;
7610
7611 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7612 locations. */
7613 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7614 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7615 {
7616 delete_breakpoint (b);
7617 return NULL;
7618 }
7619 return b;
7620 }
7621
7622 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7623 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7624
7625 void
7626 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7627 {
7628 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7629
7630 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7631 {
7632 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7633 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7634
7635 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7636 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7637 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7638 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7639 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7640 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7641 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7642 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7643 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7644 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7645 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7646 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7647 )
7648 {
7649 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7650 }
7651 }
7652 }
7653
7654 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7655 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7656 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7657
7658 static void
7659 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7660 {
7661 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7662 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7663
7664 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7665 {
7666 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7667 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7668
7669 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7670 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7671 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7672 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7673 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7674 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7675 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7676 || is_tracepoint (b))
7677 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7678 {
7679 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7680 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7681 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7682 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7683 loc->inserted = 0;
7684
7685 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7686 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7687
7688 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7689 {
7690 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7691 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7692 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7693 solib->so_name);
7694 }
7695 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7696 }
7697 }
7698 }
7699
7700 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7701 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7702 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7703
7704 static void
7705 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7706 {
7707 struct breakpoint *b;
7708
7709 if (objfile == NULL)
7710 return;
7711
7712 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7713 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7714 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7715 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7716 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7717 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7718 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7719 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7720 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7721 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7722 main objfile). */
7723 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7724 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7725 return;
7726
7727 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7728 {
7729 struct bp_location *loc;
7730 int bp_modified = 0;
7731
7732 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7733 continue;
7734
7735 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7736 {
7737 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7738
7739 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7740 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7741 continue;
7742
7743 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7744 continue;
7745
7746 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7747 continue;
7748
7749 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7750 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7751 continue;
7752
7753 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7754 {
7755 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7756 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7757 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7758 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7759 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7760 unmapped. */
7761
7762 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7763
7764 bp_modified = 1;
7765 }
7766 }
7767
7768 if (bp_modified)
7769 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7770 }
7771 }
7772
7773 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7774
7775 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7776 catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
7777 to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7778
7779 struct fork_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7780 {
7781 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7782 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7783 catchpoint has triggered. */
7784 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7785 };
7786
7787 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7788 catchpoints. */
7789
7790 static int
7791 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7792 {
7793 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7794 }
7795
7796 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7797 catchpoints. */
7798
7799 static int
7800 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7801 {
7802 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7803 }
7804
7805 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7806 catchpoints. */
7807
7808 static int
7809 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7810 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7811 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7812 {
7813 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7814
7815 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7816 return 0;
7817
7818 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7819 return 1;
7820 }
7821
7822 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7823 catchpoints. */
7824
7825 static enum print_stop_action
7826 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7827 {
7828 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7829 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7830 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7831
7832 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7833 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7834 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7835 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7836 else
7837 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7838 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7839 {
7840 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7841 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7842 }
7843 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7844 uiout->text (" (forked process ");
7845 uiout->field_int ("newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7846 uiout->text ("), ");
7847 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7848 }
7849
7850 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7851 catchpoints. */
7852
7853 static void
7854 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7855 {
7856 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7857 struct value_print_options opts;
7858 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7859
7860 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7861
7862 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7863 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7864 readable). */
7865 if (opts.addressprint)
7866 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7867 annotate_field (5);
7868 uiout->text ("fork");
7869 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
7870 {
7871 uiout->text (", process ");
7872 uiout->field_int ("what", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7873 uiout->spaces (1);
7874 }
7875
7876 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7877 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
7878 }
7879
7880 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7881 catchpoints. */
7882
7883 static void
7884 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7885 {
7886 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7887 }
7888
7889 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7890 catchpoints. */
7891
7892 static void
7893 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7894 {
7895 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7896 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7897 }
7898
7899 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7900
7901 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7902
7903 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7904 catchpoints. */
7905
7906 static int
7907 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7908 {
7909 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7910 }
7911
7912 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7913 catchpoints. */
7914
7915 static int
7916 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7917 {
7918 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7919 }
7920
7921 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7922 catchpoints. */
7923
7924 static int
7925 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7926 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7927 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7928 {
7929 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7930
7931 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7932 return 0;
7933
7934 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7935 return 1;
7936 }
7937
7938 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7939 catchpoints. */
7940
7941 static enum print_stop_action
7942 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7943 {
7944 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7945 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7946 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7947
7948 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7949 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7950 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7951 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7952 else
7953 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7954 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7955 {
7956 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7957 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7958 }
7959 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7960 uiout->text (" (vforked process ");
7961 uiout->field_int ("newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7962 uiout->text ("), ");
7963 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7964 }
7965
7966 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7967 catchpoints. */
7968
7969 static void
7970 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7971 {
7972 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7973 struct value_print_options opts;
7974 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7975
7976 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7977 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7978 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7979 readable). */
7980 if (opts.addressprint)
7981 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7982 annotate_field (5);
7983 uiout->text ("vfork");
7984 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
7985 {
7986 uiout->text (", process ");
7987 uiout->field_int ("what", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7988 uiout->spaces (1);
7989 }
7990
7991 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7992 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
7993 }
7994
7995 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7996 catchpoints. */
7997
7998 static void
7999 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
8000 {
8001 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
8002 }
8003
8004 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8005 catchpoints. */
8006
8007 static void
8008 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8009 {
8010 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
8011 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8012 }
8013
8014 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
8015
8016 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
8017
8018 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
8019 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8020 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8021
8022 struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
8023 {
8024 ~solib_catchpoint () override;
8025
8026 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
8027 unsigned char is_load;
8028
8029 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
8030 REGEX is non-NULL. */
8031 char *regex;
8032 std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
8033 };
8034
8035 solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
8036 {
8037 xfree (this->regex);
8038 }
8039
8040 static int
8041 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8042 {
8043 return 0;
8044 }
8045
8046 static int
8047 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8048 {
8049 return 0;
8050 }
8051
8052 static int
8053 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
8054 const address_space *aspace,
8055 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8056 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8057 {
8058 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8059 struct breakpoint *other;
8060
8061 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
8062 return 1;
8063
8064 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
8065 {
8066 struct bp_location *other_bl;
8067
8068 if (other == bl->owner)
8069 continue;
8070
8071 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
8072 continue;
8073
8074 if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
8075 continue;
8076
8077 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
8078 {
8079 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
8080 return 1;
8081 }
8082 }
8083
8084 return 0;
8085 }
8086
8087 static void
8088 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
8089 {
8090 struct solib_catchpoint *self
8091 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8092 int ix;
8093
8094 if (self->is_load)
8095 {
8096 struct so_list *iter;
8097
8098 for (ix = 0;
8099 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
8100 ix, iter);
8101 ++ix)
8102 {
8103 if (!self->regex
8104 || self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8105 return;
8106 }
8107 }
8108 else
8109 {
8110 char *iter;
8111
8112 for (ix = 0;
8113 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
8114 ix, iter);
8115 ++ix)
8116 {
8117 if (!self->regex
8118 || self->compiled->exec (iter, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8119 return;
8120 }
8121 }
8122
8123 bs->stop = 0;
8124 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8125 }
8126
8127 static enum print_stop_action
8128 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8129 {
8130 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8131 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8132
8133 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8134 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8135 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8136 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8137 else
8138 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8139 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8140 uiout->text ("\n");
8141 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8142 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8143 print_solib_event (1);
8144 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8145 }
8146
8147 static void
8148 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8149 {
8150 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8151 struct value_print_options opts;
8152 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8153 char *msg;
8154
8155 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8156 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8157 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8158 readable). */
8159 if (opts.addressprint)
8160 {
8161 annotate_field (4);
8162 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8163 }
8164
8165 annotate_field (5);
8166 if (self->is_load)
8167 {
8168 if (self->regex)
8169 msg = xstrprintf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8170 else
8171 msg = xstrdup (_("load of library"));
8172 }
8173 else
8174 {
8175 if (self->regex)
8176 msg = xstrprintf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8177 else
8178 msg = xstrdup (_("unload of library"));
8179 }
8180 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
8181 xfree (msg);
8182
8183 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8184 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8185 }
8186
8187 static void
8188 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8189 {
8190 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8191
8192 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8193 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8194 }
8195
8196 static void
8197 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8198 {
8199 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8200
8201 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8202 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8203 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8204 if (self->regex)
8205 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8206 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8207 }
8208
8209 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8210
8211 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8212 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8213 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8214 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8215 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8216 created in an enabled state. */
8217
8218 void
8219 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8220 {
8221 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8222
8223 if (!arg)
8224 arg = "";
8225 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8226
8227 std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
8228
8229 if (*arg != '\0')
8230 {
8231 c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
8232 _("Invalid regexp")));
8233 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8234 }
8235
8236 c->is_load = is_load;
8237 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8238 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8239
8240 c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8241
8242 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8243 }
8244
8245 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8246 "catch unload". */
8247
8248 static void
8249 catch_load_or_unload (char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8250 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8251 {
8252 int tempflag;
8253 const int enabled = 1;
8254
8255 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8256
8257 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8258 }
8259
8260 static void
8261 catch_load_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8262 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8263 {
8264 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8265 }
8266
8267 static void
8268 catch_unload_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8269 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8270 {
8271 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8272 }
8273
8274 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8275 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8276 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8277 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8278
8279 void
8280 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8281 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8282 const char *cond_string,
8283 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8284 {
8285 symtab_and_line sal;
8286 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8287
8288 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8289
8290 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8291 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8292 }
8293
8294 void
8295 install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
8296 {
8297 breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
8298 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8299 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8300 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8301 if (!internal)
8302 mention (b);
8303 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
8304
8305 if (update_gll)
8306 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8307 }
8308
8309 static void
8310 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8311 int tempflag, const char *cond_string,
8312 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8313 {
8314 std::unique_ptr<fork_catchpoint> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
8315
8316 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8317
8318 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8319
8320 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8321 }
8322
8323 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8324
8325 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8326 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8327 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8328
8329 struct exec_catchpoint : public breakpoint
8330 {
8331 ~exec_catchpoint () override;
8332
8333 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8334 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8335 triggered. */
8336 char *exec_pathname;
8337 };
8338
8339 /* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
8340
8341 exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
8342 {
8343 xfree (this->exec_pathname);
8344 }
8345
8346 static int
8347 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8348 {
8349 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8350 }
8351
8352 static int
8353 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8354 {
8355 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8356 }
8357
8358 static int
8359 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8360 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8361 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8362 {
8363 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8364
8365 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8366 return 0;
8367
8368 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8369 return 1;
8370 }
8371
8372 static enum print_stop_action
8373 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8374 {
8375 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8376 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8377 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8378
8379 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8380 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8381 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8382 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8383 else
8384 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8385 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8386 {
8387 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8388 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8389 }
8390 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8391 uiout->text (" (exec'd ");
8392 uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8393 uiout->text ("), ");
8394
8395 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8396 }
8397
8398 static void
8399 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8400 {
8401 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8402 struct value_print_options opts;
8403 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8404
8405 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8406
8407 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8408 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8409 is relatively readable). */
8410 if (opts.addressprint)
8411 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8412 annotate_field (5);
8413 uiout->text ("exec");
8414 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8415 {
8416 uiout->text (", program \"");
8417 uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname);
8418 uiout->text ("\" ");
8419 }
8420
8421 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8422 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
8423 }
8424
8425 static void
8426 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8427 {
8428 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8429 }
8430
8431 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8432 catchpoints. */
8433
8434 static void
8435 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8436 {
8437 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8438 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8439 }
8440
8441 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8442
8443 static int
8444 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8445 {
8446 int i = 0;
8447 struct breakpoint *b;
8448 struct bp_location *bl;
8449
8450 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8451 {
8452 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8453 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8454 {
8455 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8456 one register. */
8457 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8458 }
8459 }
8460
8461 return i;
8462 }
8463
8464 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8465 watchpoint. */
8466
8467 static int
8468 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8469 {
8470 int i = 0;
8471 struct bp_location *bl;
8472
8473 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8474 return 0;
8475
8476 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8477 {
8478 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8479 one register. */
8480 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8481 }
8482
8483 return i;
8484 }
8485
8486 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8487 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8488 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8489 types _not_ TYPE. */
8490
8491 static int
8492 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8493 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8494 {
8495 int i = 0;
8496 struct breakpoint *b;
8497
8498 *other_type_used = 0;
8499 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8500 {
8501 if (b == except)
8502 continue;
8503 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8504 continue;
8505
8506 if (b->type == type)
8507 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8508 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8509 *other_type_used = 1;
8510 }
8511
8512 return i;
8513 }
8514
8515 void
8516 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8517 {
8518 struct breakpoint *b;
8519
8520 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8521 {
8522 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8523 {
8524 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8525 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8526 }
8527 }
8528 }
8529
8530 void
8531 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8532 {
8533 struct breakpoint *b;
8534
8535 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8536 {
8537 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8538 {
8539 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8540 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8541 }
8542 }
8543 }
8544
8545 void
8546 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8547 {
8548 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8549 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8550 }
8551
8552 void
8553 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8554 {
8555 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8556 breakpoint_re_set ();
8557 }
8558
8559 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8560 locations. */
8561
8562 static struct breakpoint *
8563 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8564 {
8565 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
8566
8567 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8568 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8569
8570 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8571 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8572
8573 b->thread = thread;
8574 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8575
8576 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
8577 }
8578
8579 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8580 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8581 frame. */
8582
8583 breakpoint_up
8584 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8585 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8586 {
8587 struct breakpoint *b;
8588
8589 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8590 tail-called one. */
8591 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8592
8593 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8594 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8595 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8596 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8597
8598 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want
8599 momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of
8600 control. */
8601 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
8602 b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
8603
8604 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8605
8606 return breakpoint_up (b);
8607 }
8608
8609 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8610 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8611 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8612
8613 static struct breakpoint *
8614 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8615 enum bptype type,
8616 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8617 int loc_enabled)
8618 {
8619 struct breakpoint *copy;
8620
8621 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8622 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8623 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8624
8625 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8626 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8627 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8628 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8629 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8630 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8631 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8632 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8633 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8634 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8635 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8636 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8637
8638 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8639 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8640 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8641
8642 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8643 return copy;
8644 }
8645
8646 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8647 ORIG is NULL. */
8648
8649 struct breakpoint *
8650 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8651 {
8652 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8653 if (orig == NULL)
8654 return NULL;
8655
8656 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8657 }
8658
8659 breakpoint_up
8660 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8661 enum bptype type)
8662 {
8663 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8664
8665 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8666 sal.pc = pc;
8667 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8668 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8669
8670 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8671 }
8672 \f
8673
8674 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8675
8676 static void
8677 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8678 {
8679 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8680 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8681 return;
8682 printf_filtered ("\n");
8683 }
8684 \f
8685
8686 static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8687
8688 static struct bp_location *
8689 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8690 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8691 {
8692 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8693 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8694 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8695
8696 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8697 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8698
8699 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8700 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8701 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8702 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8703 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8704 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8705 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8706 sal->pc, b->type);
8707
8708 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8709 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8710 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8711 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8712 ;
8713 loc->next = *tmp;
8714 *tmp = loc;
8715
8716 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8717 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8718 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8719 loc->probe.probe = sal->probe;
8720 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8721 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8722 loc->section = sal->section;
8723 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8724 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8725 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8726 loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
8727
8728 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
8729 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
8730
8731 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8732 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8733 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8734 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8735 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8736 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8737 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8738 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8739 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8740 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8741 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8742 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8743 instruction.) */
8744 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8745 loc->permanent = 1;
8746
8747 return loc;
8748 }
8749 \f
8750
8751 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8752
8753 int
8754 program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
8755 {
8756 int len;
8757 CORE_ADDR addr;
8758 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
8759 gdb_byte *target_mem;
8760
8761 addr = address;
8762 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len);
8763
8764 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
8765 if (bpoint == NULL)
8766 return 0;
8767
8768 target_mem = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
8769
8770 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
8771 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
8772 breakpoints they are permanent. */
8773 scoped_restore restore_memory
8774 = make_scoped_restore_show_memory_breakpoints (0);
8775
8776 if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0
8777 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
8778 return 1;
8779
8780 return 0;
8781 }
8782
8783 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8784 return 0 otherwise. */
8785
8786 static int
8787 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8788 {
8789 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8790
8791 /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0. We should not
8792 attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types
8793 point to. program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8794 memory. */
8795 if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner))
8796 return 0;
8797
8798 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
8799 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8800 return program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
8801 }
8802
8803 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8804 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8805
8806 static void
8807 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8808 {
8809 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
8810 char *printf_line = NULL;
8811
8812 if (!dprintf_args)
8813 return;
8814
8815 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8816
8817 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8818 insist on it. */
8819 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8820 ++dprintf_args;
8821 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8822
8823 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8824 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8825
8826 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
8827 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8828 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
8829 {
8830 if (!dprintf_function)
8831 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8832
8833 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
8834 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8835 dprintf_function,
8836 dprintf_channel,
8837 dprintf_args);
8838 else
8839 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8840 dprintf_function,
8841 dprintf_args);
8842 }
8843 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
8844 {
8845 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8846 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
8847 else
8848 {
8849 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8850 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8851 }
8852 }
8853 else
8854 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8855 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8856
8857 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
8858 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8859 {
8860 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line = XNEW (struct command_line);
8861
8862 printf_cmd_line->control_type = simple_control;
8863 printf_cmd_line->body_count = 0;
8864 printf_cmd_line->body_list = NULL;
8865 printf_cmd_line->next = NULL;
8866 printf_cmd_line->line = printf_line;
8867
8868 breakpoint_set_commands (b, command_line_up (printf_cmd_line));
8869 }
8870 }
8871
8872 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8873 current style settings. */
8874
8875 static void
8876 update_dprintf_commands (char *args, int from_tty,
8877 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8878 {
8879 struct breakpoint *b;
8880
8881 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8882 {
8883 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8884 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8885 }
8886 }
8887
8888 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8889 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8890 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8891 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8892
8893 static void
8894 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8895 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8896 event_location_up &&location,
8897 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8898 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8899 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8900 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8901 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8902 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8903 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8904 int display_canonical)
8905 {
8906 int i;
8907
8908 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8909 {
8910 int target_resources_ok;
8911
8912 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8913 target_resources_ok =
8914 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8915 i + 1, 0);
8916 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8917 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8918 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8919 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8920 }
8921
8922 gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
8923
8924 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8925 {
8926 struct bp_location *loc;
8927
8928 if (from_tty)
8929 {
8930 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8931 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8932 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8933
8934 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8935 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8936 }
8937
8938 if (&sal == &sals[0])
8939 {
8940 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8941 b->thread = thread;
8942 b->task = task;
8943
8944 b->cond_string = cond_string.release ();
8945 b->extra_string = extra_string.release ();
8946 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8947 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8948 b->disposition = disposition;
8949
8950 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8951 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8952
8953 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8954 {
8955 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8956 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8957
8958 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8959 {
8960 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8961 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8962 const char *p
8963 = &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
8964 const char *endp;
8965 char *marker_str;
8966
8967 p = skip_spaces (p);
8968
8969 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8970
8971 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
8972 t->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
8973
8974 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8975 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8976 t->static_trace_marker_id);
8977 }
8978 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8979 {
8980 t->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
8981 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
8982
8983 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8984 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8985 t->static_trace_marker_id);
8986 }
8987 else
8988 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8989 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8990 }
8991
8992 loc = b->loc;
8993 }
8994 else
8995 {
8996 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8997 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8998 loc->inserted = 1;
8999 }
9000
9001 if (b->cond_string)
9002 {
9003 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
9004
9005 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
9006 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
9007 if (*arg)
9008 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
9009 }
9010
9011 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
9012 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
9013 if (type == bp_dprintf)
9014 {
9015 if (b->extra_string)
9016 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9017 else
9018 error (_("Format string required"));
9019 }
9020 else if (b->extra_string)
9021 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
9022 }
9023
9024 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
9025 if (location != NULL)
9026 b->location = std::move (location);
9027 else
9028 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
9029 b->filter = filter.release ();
9030 }
9031
9032 static void
9033 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9034 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
9035 event_location_up &&location,
9036 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
9037 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
9038 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
9039 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9040 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9041 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9042 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9043 int display_canonical)
9044 {
9045 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
9046
9047 init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
9048 sals, std::move (location),
9049 std::move (filter),
9050 std::move (cond_string),
9051 std::move (extra_string),
9052 type, disposition,
9053 thread, task, ignore_count,
9054 ops, from_tty,
9055 enabled, internal, flags,
9056 display_canonical);
9057
9058 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9059 }
9060
9061 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
9062 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
9063 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
9064 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
9065 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
9066 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
9067 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
9068 we take just a single condition string.
9069
9070 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
9071 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
9072 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
9073 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
9074 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
9075
9076 static void
9077 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9078 struct linespec_result *canonical,
9079 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
9080 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
9081 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9082 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9083 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9084 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
9085 {
9086 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
9087 gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
9088
9089 for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
9090 {
9091 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
9092 'break', without arguments. */
9093 event_location_up location
9094 = (canonical->location != NULL
9095 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
9096 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
9097 (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
9098
9099 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
9100 std::move (location),
9101 std::move (filter_string),
9102 std::move (cond_string),
9103 std::move (extra_string),
9104 type, disposition,
9105 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9106 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
9107 canonical->special_display);
9108 }
9109 }
9110
9111 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
9112 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
9113 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
9114 linespec locations).
9115
9116 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
9117 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
9118
9119 static void
9120 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
9121 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9122 {
9123 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
9124
9125 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9126 {
9127 const char *address = get_linespec_location (location);
9128
9129 if (address == NULL)
9130 {
9131 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
9132 breakpoint address. */
9133 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9134 {
9135 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9136 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9137 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9138 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9139 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9140 symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
9141 CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
9142
9143 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9144
9145 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9146 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9147 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9148 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9149 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9150 sal.pc = pc;
9151 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9152
9153 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9154 lsal.sals = {sal};
9155 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9156
9157 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
9158 return;
9159 }
9160 else
9161 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9162 }
9163 }
9164
9165 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9166 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9167 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9168 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9169
9170 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9171 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9172 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9173 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9174 {
9175 const char *address = NULL;
9176
9177 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9178 address = get_linespec_location (location);
9179
9180 if (!cursal.symtab
9181 || (address != NULL
9182 && strchr ("+-", address[0]) != NULL
9183 && address[1] != '['))
9184 {
9185 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9186 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9187 get_last_displayed_line (),
9188 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9189 return;
9190 }
9191 }
9192
9193 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9194 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9195 }
9196
9197
9198 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9199 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9200
9201 static void
9202 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
9203 {
9204 for (auto &sal : sals)
9205 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
9206 }
9207
9208 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9209 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9210 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9211 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9212 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9213 it, etc. */
9214
9215 static void
9216 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9217 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
9218 {
9219 int rslt;
9220 char *msg;
9221 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9222
9223 for (const auto &sal : sals)
9224 {
9225 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9226
9227 sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9228 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9229 associated with SAL. */
9230 if (sarch == NULL)
9231 sarch = gdbarch;
9232 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg);
9233 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
9234
9235 if (!rslt)
9236 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9237 paddress (sarch, sal.pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
9238
9239 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9240 }
9241 }
9242
9243 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9244 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9245 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9246 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9247 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9248 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9249
9250 static void
9251 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9252 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9253 char **rest)
9254 {
9255 *cond_string = NULL;
9256 *thread = -1;
9257 *task = 0;
9258 *rest = NULL;
9259
9260 while (tok && *tok)
9261 {
9262 const char *end_tok;
9263 int toklen;
9264 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9265 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9266
9267 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
9268
9269 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9270 {
9271 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9272 return;
9273 }
9274
9275 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
9276
9277 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9278
9279 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9280 {
9281 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9282 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9283 cond_end = tok;
9284 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9285 }
9286 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9287 {
9288 const char *tmptok;
9289 struct thread_info *thr;
9290
9291 tok = end_tok + 1;
9292 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9293 if (tok == tmptok)
9294 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9295 *thread = thr->global_num;
9296 tok = tmptok;
9297 }
9298 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9299 {
9300 char *tmptok;
9301
9302 tok = end_tok + 1;
9303 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9304 if (tok == tmptok)
9305 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9306 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9307 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9308 tok = tmptok;
9309 }
9310 else if (rest)
9311 {
9312 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9313 return;
9314 }
9315 else
9316 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9317 }
9318 }
9319
9320 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9321
9322 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
9323 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9324 {
9325 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
9326 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9327 const char *endp;
9328 int i;
9329
9330 p = skip_spaces (p);
9331
9332 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9333
9334 std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
9335
9336 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
9337 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
9338 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
9339 marker_str.c_str ());
9340
9341 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
9342 sals.reserve (VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers));
9343
9344 for (i = 0; i < VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers); i++)
9345 {
9346 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
9347
9348 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
9349
9350 symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
9351 sal.pc = marker->address;
9352 sals.push_back (sal);
9353
9354 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
9355 }
9356
9357 *arg_p = endp;
9358 return sals;
9359 }
9360
9361 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9362
9363 int
9364 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9365 const struct event_location *location,
9366 const char *cond_string,
9367 int thread, const char *extra_string,
9368 int parse_extra,
9369 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9370 int ignore_count,
9371 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9372 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9373 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9374 unsigned flags)
9375 {
9376 struct linespec_result canonical;
9377 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9378 int pending = 0;
9379 int task = 0;
9380 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9381
9382 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9383
9384 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9385 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9386 extra_string = NULL;
9387
9388 TRY
9389 {
9390 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9391 }
9392 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9393 {
9394 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9395 value. */
9396 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9397 {
9398 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9399 error. */
9400
9401 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9402 throw_exception (e);
9403
9404 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9405
9406 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9407 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9408 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9409 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9410 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9411 return 0;
9412
9413 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9414 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9415 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9416 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9417 pending = 1;
9418 }
9419 else
9420 throw_exception (e);
9421 }
9422 END_CATCH
9423
9424 if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
9425 return 0;
9426
9427 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
9428 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
9429 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
9430 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
9431 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
9432
9433 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9434 are ok for the target. */
9435 if (!pending)
9436 {
9437 for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9438 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
9439 }
9440
9441 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9442 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9443 {
9444 for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9445 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
9446 }
9447
9448 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9449 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9450 breakpoint. */
9451 if (!pending)
9452 {
9453 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
9454 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
9455
9456 if (parse_extra)
9457 {
9458 char *rest;
9459 char *cond;
9460
9461 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9462
9463 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9464 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9465 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9466 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9467
9468 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal.sals[0].pc,
9469 &cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
9470 cond_string_copy.reset (cond);
9471 extra_string_copy.reset (rest);
9472 }
9473 else
9474 {
9475 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9476 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9477 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9478
9479 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9480 if (cond_string)
9481 cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
9482 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9483 if (extra_string)
9484 extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
9485 }
9486
9487 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9488 std::move (cond_string_copy),
9489 std::move (extra_string_copy),
9490 type_wanted,
9491 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9492 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9493 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9494 }
9495 else
9496 {
9497 std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
9498
9499 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9500 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9501
9502 if (parse_extra)
9503 b->cond_string = NULL;
9504 else
9505 {
9506 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9507 b->cond_string = cond_string != NULL ? xstrdup (cond_string) : NULL;
9508 b->thread = thread;
9509 }
9510
9511 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9512 b->extra_string = extra_string != NULL ? xstrdup (extra_string) : NULL;
9513 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9514 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9515 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9516 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9517 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9518 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9519 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9520
9521 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9522 }
9523
9524 if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
9525 {
9526 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9527 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9528 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9529 }
9530
9531 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
9532 breakpoint. */
9533 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
9534
9535 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
9536 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9537
9538 return 1;
9539 }
9540
9541 /* Set a breakpoint.
9542 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9543 condition, and thread.
9544 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9545 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9546 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9547
9548 static void
9549 break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9550 {
9551 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9552 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9553 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9554 : bp_breakpoint);
9555 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
9556
9557 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9558
9559 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
9560 if (location != NULL
9561 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
9562 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9563 else
9564 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9565
9566 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9567 location.get (),
9568 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9569 tempflag, type_wanted,
9570 0 /* Ignore count */,
9571 pending_break_support,
9572 ops,
9573 from_tty,
9574 1 /* enabled */,
9575 0 /* internal */,
9576 0);
9577 }
9578
9579 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9580
9581 void
9582 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9583 {
9584 CORE_ADDR pc;
9585
9586 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9587 {
9588 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9589 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9590 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9591 sal->pc = pc;
9592
9593 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9594 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9595 if (sal->explicit_line)
9596 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9597 }
9598
9599 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9600 {
9601 const struct blockvector *bv;
9602 const struct block *b;
9603 struct symbol *sym;
9604
9605 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9606 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9607 if (bv != NULL)
9608 {
9609 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9610 if (sym != NULL)
9611 {
9612 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9613 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
9614 sym);
9615 }
9616 else
9617 {
9618 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9619 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9620 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9621 happen in assembly source). */
9622
9623 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
9624 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9625
9626 bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9627 if (msym.minsym)
9628 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
9629 }
9630 }
9631 }
9632 }
9633
9634 void
9635 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9636 {
9637 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9638 }
9639
9640 void
9641 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9642 {
9643 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9644 }
9645
9646 static void
9647 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9648 {
9649 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9650 }
9651
9652 static void
9653 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9654 {
9655 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9656 }
9657
9658 static void
9659 stop_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9660 {
9661 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9662 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9663 stop at <line>\n"));
9664 }
9665
9666 static void
9667 stopin_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9668 {
9669 int badInput = 0;
9670
9671 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
9672 badInput = 1;
9673 else if (*arg != '*')
9674 {
9675 const char *argptr = arg;
9676 int hasColon = 0;
9677
9678 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9679 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9680 function/method name. */
9681 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9682 {
9683 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9684 argptr++;
9685 }
9686
9687 if (hasColon)
9688 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9689 else
9690 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
9691 }
9692
9693 if (badInput)
9694 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9695 else
9696 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9697 }
9698
9699 static void
9700 stopat_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9701 {
9702 int badInput = 0;
9703
9704 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
9705 badInput = 1;
9706 else
9707 {
9708 const char *argptr = arg;
9709 int hasColon = 0;
9710
9711 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9712 it is probably a line number. */
9713 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9714 {
9715 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9716 argptr++;
9717 }
9718
9719 if (hasColon)
9720 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
9721 else
9722 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
9723 }
9724
9725 if (badInput)
9726 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
9727 else
9728 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9729 }
9730
9731 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9732 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9733 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9734 line. */
9735
9736 static void
9737 dprintf_command (char *arg_in, int from_tty)
9738 {
9739 const char *arg = arg_in;
9740 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9741
9742 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9743 the next character must be ','. */
9744 if (arg != NULL)
9745 {
9746 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
9747 error (_("Format string required"));
9748 else
9749 {
9750 /* Skip the comma. */
9751 ++arg;
9752 }
9753 }
9754
9755 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9756 location.get (),
9757 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9758 0, bp_dprintf,
9759 0 /* Ignore count */,
9760 pending_break_support,
9761 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9762 from_tty,
9763 1 /* enabled */,
9764 0 /* internal */,
9765 0);
9766 }
9767
9768 static void
9769 agent_printf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9770 {
9771 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9772 }
9773
9774 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9775 ranged breakpoints. */
9776
9777 static int
9778 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9779 const address_space *aspace,
9780 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9781 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
9782 {
9783 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9784 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9785 return 0;
9786
9787 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9788 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9789 }
9790
9791 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9792 ranged breakpoints. */
9793
9794 static int
9795 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9796 {
9797 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9798 }
9799
9800 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9801 ranged breakpoints. */
9802
9803 static enum print_stop_action
9804 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
9805 {
9806 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9807 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9808 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9809
9810 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9811
9812 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9813 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9814
9815 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9816
9817 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9818
9819 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9820 uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9821 else
9822 uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9823 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9824 {
9825 uiout->field_string ("reason",
9826 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9827 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9828 }
9829 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
9830 uiout->text (", ");
9831
9832 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9833 }
9834
9835 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9836 ranged breakpoints. */
9837
9838 static void
9839 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9840 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9841 {
9842 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9843 struct value_print_options opts;
9844 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9845
9846 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9847 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9848
9849 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9850
9851 if (opts.addressprint)
9852 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9853 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9854 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
9855 annotate_field (5);
9856 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9857 *last_loc = bl;
9858 }
9859
9860 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9861 ranged breakpoints. */
9862
9863 static void
9864 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9865 struct ui_out *uiout)
9866 {
9867 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9868 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9869 string_file stb;
9870
9871 gdb_assert (bl);
9872
9873 address_start = bl->address;
9874 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9875
9876 uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
9877 stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9878 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9879 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9880 uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
9881 uiout->text ("\n");
9882 }
9883
9884 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9885 ranged breakpoints. */
9886
9887 static void
9888 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9889 {
9890 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9891 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9892
9893 gdb_assert (bl);
9894 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9895
9896 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9897 return;
9898
9899 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9900 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9901 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9902 }
9903
9904 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9905 ranged breakpoints. */
9906
9907 static void
9908 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9909 {
9910 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
9911 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
9912 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
9913 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9914 }
9915
9916 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9917
9918 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9919
9920 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9921 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9922 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9923 last instruction of the given line. */
9924
9925 static CORE_ADDR
9926 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9927 {
9928 CORE_ADDR end;
9929
9930 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9931 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9932 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9933 end = sal.pc;
9934 else
9935 {
9936 int ret;
9937 CORE_ADDR start;
9938
9939 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9940 if (!ret)
9941 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9942
9943 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9944 end--;
9945 }
9946
9947 return end;
9948 }
9949
9950 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9951
9952 static void
9953 break_range_command (char *arg_in, int from_tty)
9954 {
9955 const char *arg = arg_in;
9956 const char *arg_start;
9957 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9958 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9959 CORE_ADDR end;
9960 struct breakpoint *b;
9961
9962 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9963 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9964 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9965
9966 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9967 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9968 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9969 bp_count, 0);
9970 if (can_use_bp < 0)
9971 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9972
9973 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9974 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9975 error(_("No address range specified."));
9976
9977 arg_start = arg;
9978 event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9979 current_language);
9980 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
9981
9982 if (arg[0] != ',')
9983 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9984 else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
9985 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9986
9987 const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
9988
9989 if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
9990 || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
9991 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9992
9993 const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
9994 std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
9995
9996 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
9997 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9998
9999 /* Parse the end location. */
10000
10001 arg_start = arg;
10002
10003 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
10004 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
10005 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
10006 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
10007 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
10008 event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
10009 current_language);
10010 decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
10011 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
10012 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
10013
10014 if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
10015 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10016
10017 const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
10018 if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
10019 || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
10020 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10021
10022 const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
10023
10024 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
10025 if (sal_start.pc > end)
10026 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
10027
10028 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
10029 if (length < 0)
10030 /* Length overflowed. */
10031 error (_("Address range too large."));
10032 else if (length == 1)
10033 {
10034 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
10035 the `hbreak' command. */
10036 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
10037
10038 return;
10039 }
10040
10041 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
10042 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
10043 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
10044 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
10045 b->number = breakpoint_count;
10046 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10047 b->location = std::move (start_location);
10048 b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
10049 b->loc->length = length;
10050
10051 mention (b);
10052 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
10053 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
10054 }
10055
10056 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
10057 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
10058 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
10059 zero. */
10060
10061 static int
10062 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
10063 {
10064 int i = exp->nelts;
10065
10066 while (i > 0)
10067 {
10068 int oplenp, argsp;
10069
10070 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
10071 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
10072 i -= oplenp;
10073
10074 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
10075 {
10076 case BINOP_ADD:
10077 case BINOP_SUB:
10078 case BINOP_MUL:
10079 case BINOP_DIV:
10080 case BINOP_REM:
10081 case BINOP_MOD:
10082 case BINOP_LSH:
10083 case BINOP_RSH:
10084 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10085 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10086 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10087 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10088 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10089 case BINOP_EQUAL:
10090 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10091 case BINOP_LESS:
10092 case BINOP_GTR:
10093 case BINOP_LEQ:
10094 case BINOP_GEQ:
10095 case BINOP_REPEAT:
10096 case BINOP_COMMA:
10097 case BINOP_EXP:
10098 case BINOP_MIN:
10099 case BINOP_MAX:
10100 case BINOP_INTDIV:
10101 case BINOP_CONCAT:
10102 case TERNOP_COND:
10103 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10104
10105 case OP_LONG:
10106 case OP_FLOAT:
10107 case OP_LAST:
10108 case OP_COMPLEX:
10109 case OP_STRING:
10110 case OP_ARRAY:
10111 case OP_TYPE:
10112 case OP_TYPEOF:
10113 case OP_DECLTYPE:
10114 case OP_TYPEID:
10115 case OP_NAME:
10116 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
10117
10118 case UNOP_NEG:
10119 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10120 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
10121 case UNOP_ADDR:
10122 case UNOP_HIGH:
10123 case UNOP_CAST:
10124
10125 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
10126 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
10127 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
10128 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
10129 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
10130 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
10131 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
10132
10133 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
10134 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
10135 ADDR is. */
10136 break;
10137
10138 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10139 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
10140
10141 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
10142 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
10143 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
10144 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
10145
10146 We also have to check for function symbols because they
10147 are always constant. */
10148 {
10149 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
10150
10151 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
10152 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
10153 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
10154 return 0;
10155 break;
10156 }
10157
10158 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
10159 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
10160 then it is not a constant. */
10161 default:
10162 return 0;
10163 }
10164 }
10165
10166 return 1;
10167 }
10168
10169 /* Watchpoint destructor. */
10170
10171 watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
10172 {
10173 xfree (this->exp_string);
10174 xfree (this->exp_string_reparse);
10175 value_free (this->val);
10176 }
10177
10178 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10179
10180 static void
10181 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10182 {
10183 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10184
10185 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10186 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10187
10188 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10189 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10190 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10191 are loaded and unloaded.
10192
10193 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10194 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10195 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10196 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10197 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10198 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10199
10200 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10201 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10202 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10203 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10204
10205 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10206 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10207
10208 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10209 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10210 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10211 }
10212
10213 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10214
10215 static int
10216 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10217 {
10218 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10219 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10220
10221 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10222 w->cond_exp.get ());
10223 }
10224
10225 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10226
10227 static int
10228 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10229 {
10230 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10231 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10232
10233 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10234 w->cond_exp.get ());
10235 }
10236
10237 static int
10238 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10239 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10240 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10241 {
10242 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10243 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10244
10245 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10246 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10247 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10248 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10249 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10250 (did not match the data address). */
10251 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10252 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10253 return 0;
10254
10255 return 1;
10256 }
10257
10258 static void
10259 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10260 {
10261 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10262
10263 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10264 }
10265
10266 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10267 hardware watchpoints. */
10268
10269 static int
10270 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10271 {
10272 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10273 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10274
10275 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10276 }
10277
10278 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10279 hardware watchpoints. */
10280
10281 static int
10282 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10283 {
10284 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10285 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10286 }
10287
10288 static enum print_stop_action
10289 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10290 {
10291 struct breakpoint *b;
10292 enum print_stop_action result;
10293 struct watchpoint *w;
10294 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10295
10296 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10297
10298 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10299 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10300
10301 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10302 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10303
10304 string_file stb;
10305
10306 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
10307 switch (b->type)
10308 {
10309 case bp_watchpoint:
10310 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10311 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10312 uiout->field_string
10313 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10314 mention (b);
10315 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10316 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10317 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, &stb);
10318 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10319 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10320 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, &stb);
10321 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10322 uiout->text ("\n");
10323 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10324 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10325 break;
10326
10327 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10328 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10329 uiout->field_string
10330 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10331 mention (b);
10332 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10333 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10334 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, &stb);
10335 uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
10336 uiout->text ("\n");
10337 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10338 break;
10339
10340 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10341 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10342 {
10343 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10344 uiout->field_string
10345 ("reason",
10346 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10347 mention (b);
10348 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10349 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10350 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, &stb);
10351 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10352 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10353 }
10354 else
10355 {
10356 mention (b);
10357 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10358 uiout->field_string
10359 ("reason",
10360 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10361 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10362 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10363 }
10364 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, &stb);
10365 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10366 uiout->text ("\n");
10367 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10368 break;
10369 default:
10370 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10371 }
10372
10373 return result;
10374 }
10375
10376 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10377 watchpoints. */
10378
10379 static void
10380 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10381 {
10382 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10383 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10384 const char *tuple_name;
10385
10386 switch (b->type)
10387 {
10388 case bp_watchpoint:
10389 uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
10390 tuple_name = "wpt";
10391 break;
10392 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10393 uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
10394 tuple_name = "wpt";
10395 break;
10396 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10397 uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
10398 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10399 break;
10400 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10401 uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10402 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10403 break;
10404 default:
10405 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10406 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10407 }
10408
10409 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10410 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10411 uiout->text (": ");
10412 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10413 }
10414
10415 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10416 watchpoints. */
10417
10418 static void
10419 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10420 {
10421 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10422
10423 switch (b->type)
10424 {
10425 case bp_watchpoint:
10426 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10427 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10428 break;
10429 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10430 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10431 break;
10432 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10433 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10434 break;
10435 default:
10436 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10437 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10438 }
10439
10440 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10441 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10442 }
10443
10444 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10445 watchpoints. */
10446
10447 static int
10448 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10449 {
10450 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10451 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10452 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10453 return 0;
10454
10455 return 1;
10456 }
10457
10458 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10459
10460 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10461
10462 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10463 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10464
10465 static int
10466 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10467 {
10468 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10469
10470 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10471 bl->watchpoint_type);
10472 }
10473
10474 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10475 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10476
10477 static int
10478 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10479 {
10480 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10481
10482 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10483 bl->watchpoint_type);
10484 }
10485
10486 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10487 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10488
10489 static int
10490 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10491 {
10492 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10493
10494 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10495 }
10496
10497 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10498 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10499
10500 static int
10501 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10502 {
10503 return 0;
10504 }
10505
10506 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10507 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10508
10509 static enum print_stop_action
10510 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10511 {
10512 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10513 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10514
10515 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10516 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10517
10518 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10519 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10520
10521 switch (b->type)
10522 {
10523 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10524 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10525 uiout->field_string
10526 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10527 break;
10528
10529 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10530 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10531 uiout->field_string
10532 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10533 break;
10534
10535 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10536 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10537 uiout->field_string
10538 ("reason",
10539 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10540 break;
10541 default:
10542 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10543 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10544 }
10545
10546 mention (b);
10547 uiout->text (_("\n\
10548 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10549 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10550 uiout->text ("\n");
10551
10552 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10553 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10554 }
10555
10556 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10557 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10558
10559 static void
10560 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10561 struct ui_out *uiout)
10562 {
10563 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10564
10565 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10566 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10567
10568 uiout->text ("\tmask ");
10569 uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10570 uiout->text ("\n");
10571 }
10572
10573 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10574 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10575
10576 static void
10577 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10578 {
10579 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10580 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10581 const char *tuple_name;
10582
10583 switch (b->type)
10584 {
10585 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10586 uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10587 tuple_name = "wpt";
10588 break;
10589 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10590 uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10591 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10592 break;
10593 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10594 uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10595 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10596 break;
10597 default:
10598 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10599 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10600 }
10601
10602 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10603 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10604 uiout->text (": ");
10605 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10606 }
10607
10608 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10609 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10610
10611 static void
10612 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10613 {
10614 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10615 char tmp[40];
10616
10617 switch (b->type)
10618 {
10619 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10620 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10621 break;
10622 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10623 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10624 break;
10625 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10626 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10627 break;
10628 default:
10629 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10630 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10631 }
10632
10633 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
10634 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
10635 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10636 }
10637
10638 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10639
10640 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10641
10642 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10643
10644 static int
10645 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10646 {
10647 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10648 }
10649
10650 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10651 hw_read: watch read,
10652 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10653 static void
10654 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10655 int just_location, int internal)
10656 {
10657 struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10658 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10659 struct value *val, *mark, *result;
10660 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
10661 const char *exp_start = NULL;
10662 const char *exp_end = NULL;
10663 const char *tok, *end_tok;
10664 int toklen = -1;
10665 const char *cond_start = NULL;
10666 const char *cond_end = NULL;
10667 enum bptype bp_type;
10668 int thread = -1;
10669 int pc = 0;
10670 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10671 the hardware watchpoint. */
10672 int use_mask = 0;
10673 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10674
10675 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10676 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10677 {
10678 const char *value_start;
10679
10680 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
10681
10682 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10683 of the arguments string. */
10684 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10685 {
10686 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10687 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10688 tok--;
10689
10690 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10691 This is the value of the parameter. */
10692 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10693 tok--;
10694 value_start = tok + 1;
10695
10696 /* Skip whitespace. */
10697 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10698 tok--;
10699
10700 end_tok = tok;
10701
10702 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10703 This is the parameter itself. */
10704 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10705 tok--;
10706 tok++;
10707 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10708
10709 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
10710 {
10711 struct thread_info *thr;
10712 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10713 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10714 only in a specific thread. */
10715 const char *endp;
10716
10717 if (thread != -1)
10718 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10719
10720 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10721 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
10722
10723 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10724 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10725 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
10726
10727 thread = thr->global_num;
10728 }
10729 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
10730 {
10731 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10732 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10733 facility. */
10734 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10735
10736 if (use_mask)
10737 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10738
10739 use_mask = just_location = 1;
10740
10741 mark = value_mark ();
10742 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10743 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10744 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10745 }
10746 else
10747 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10748 break;
10749
10750 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10751 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10752 exp_end = tok;
10753 }
10754 }
10755 else
10756 exp_end = arg;
10757
10758 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10759 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10760 ARG. */
10761 innermost_block = NULL;
10762 std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
10763 exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
10764 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
10765 exp_end = arg;
10766 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10767 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10768 prettier. */
10769 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10770 --exp_end;
10771
10772 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10773 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
10774 {
10775 int len;
10776
10777 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10778 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10779 len--;
10780 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10781 }
10782
10783 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
10784 mark = value_mark ();
10785 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), &pc, &val, &result, NULL, just_location);
10786
10787 if (val != NULL && just_location)
10788 {
10789 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val);
10790 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val);
10791 }
10792
10793 if (just_location)
10794 {
10795 int ret;
10796
10797 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10798 val = value_addr (result);
10799 release_value (val);
10800 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10801
10802 if (use_mask)
10803 {
10804 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val),
10805 mask);
10806 if (ret == -1)
10807 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10808 else if (ret == -2)
10809 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10810 }
10811 }
10812 else if (val != NULL)
10813 release_value (val);
10814
10815 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10816 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10817
10818 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10819 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10820 {
10821 innermost_block = NULL;
10822 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10823 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
10824
10825 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10826 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10827 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
10828
10829 cond_end = tok;
10830 }
10831 if (*tok)
10832 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10833
10834 frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10835
10836 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10837 'wp_frame'. */
10838 frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
10839
10840 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10841 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10842 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10843 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10844 if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
10845 {
10846 frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
10847
10848 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10849 {
10850 gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
10851 CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
10852
10853 scope_breakpoint
10854 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
10855 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10856 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10857
10858 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10859 wp_frame = NULL;
10860
10861 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10862
10863 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10864 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10865
10866 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10867 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
10868
10869 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10870 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
10871 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
10872 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10873 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10874 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10875 scope_breakpoint->type);
10876 }
10877 }
10878
10879 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10880 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10881 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10882 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10883
10884 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10885 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10886 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10887 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10888 else
10889 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10890
10891 std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
10892
10893 if (use_mask)
10894 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10895 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10896 else
10897 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10898 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10899 w->thread = thread;
10900 w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10901 w->pspace = current_program_space;
10902 w->exp = std::move (exp);
10903 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10904 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10905 if (just_location)
10906 {
10907 struct type *t = value_type (val);
10908 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val);
10909
10910 w->exp_string_reparse
10911 = current_language->la_watch_location_expression (t, addr).release ();
10912
10913 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10914 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10915 }
10916 else
10917 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
10918
10919 if (use_mask)
10920 {
10921 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10922 }
10923 else
10924 {
10925 w->val = val;
10926 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
10927 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
10928 w->val_valid = 1;
10929 }
10930
10931 if (cond_start)
10932 w->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
10933 else
10934 w->cond_string = 0;
10935
10936 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
10937 {
10938 w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
10939 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10940 }
10941 else
10942 {
10943 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10944 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10945 }
10946
10947 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10948 {
10949 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10950 need to act on them together. */
10951 w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10952 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
10953 }
10954
10955 if (!just_location)
10956 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10957
10958 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10959 that should be inserted. */
10960 update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
10961
10962 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
10963 }
10964
10965 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10966 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10967
10968 static int
10969 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
10970 {
10971 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10972 struct value *head = v;
10973
10974 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10975 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10976 return 0;
10977
10978 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10979 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10980 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10981 hardware watchpoint.
10982
10983 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10984 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10985 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10986 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10987 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10988 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10989 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10990 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10991 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10992
10993 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10994 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10995 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10996 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10997 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
10998 {
10999 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
11000 {
11001 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
11002 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
11003 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
11004 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
11005 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
11006 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
11007 ;
11008 else
11009 {
11010 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
11011 it with hardware watchpoints. */
11012 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
11013
11014 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
11015 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
11016 middle of some value chain. */
11017 if (v == head
11018 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
11019 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
11020 {
11021 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
11022 int len;
11023 int num_regs;
11024
11025 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
11026 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
11027 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
11028
11029 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
11030 if (!num_regs)
11031 return 0;
11032 else
11033 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
11034 }
11035 }
11036 }
11037 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
11038 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
11039 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
11040 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
11041 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
11042 }
11043
11044 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
11045 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
11046 return found_memory_cnt;
11047 }
11048
11049 void
11050 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11051 {
11052 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
11053 }
11054
11055 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
11056 calls watch_command_1. */
11057
11058 static void
11059 watch_maybe_just_location (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
11060 {
11061 int just_location = 0;
11062
11063 if (arg
11064 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
11065 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
11066 {
11067 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11068 just_location = 1;
11069 }
11070
11071 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
11072 }
11073
11074 static void
11075 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11076 {
11077 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
11078 }
11079
11080 void
11081 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11082 {
11083 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
11084 }
11085
11086 static void
11087 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11088 {
11089 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
11090 }
11091
11092 void
11093 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11094 {
11095 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
11096 }
11097
11098 static void
11099 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11100 {
11101 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
11102 }
11103 \f
11104
11105 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
11106 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
11107 breakpoints. */
11108
11109 struct until_break_fsm
11110 {
11111 /* The base class. */
11112 struct thread_fsm thread_fsm;
11113
11114 /* The thread that as current when the command was executed. */
11115 int thread;
11116
11117 /* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
11118 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint;
11119
11120 /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
11121 NULL. */
11122 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint;
11123 };
11124
11125 static void until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11126 struct thread_info *thread);
11127 static int until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11128 struct thread_info *thread);
11129 static enum async_reply_reason
11130 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self);
11131
11132 /* until_break_fsm's vtable. */
11133
11134 static struct thread_fsm_ops until_break_fsm_ops =
11135 {
11136 NULL, /* dtor */
11137 until_break_fsm_clean_up,
11138 until_break_fsm_should_stop,
11139 NULL, /* return_value */
11140 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason,
11141 };
11142
11143 /* Allocate a new until_break_command_fsm. */
11144
11145 static struct until_break_fsm *
11146 new_until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
11147 breakpoint_up &&location_breakpoint,
11148 breakpoint_up &&caller_breakpoint)
11149 {
11150 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11151
11152 sm = XCNEW (struct until_break_fsm);
11153 thread_fsm_ctor (&sm->thread_fsm, &until_break_fsm_ops, cmd_interp);
11154
11155 sm->thread = thread;
11156 sm->location_breakpoint = location_breakpoint.release ();
11157 sm->caller_breakpoint = caller_breakpoint.release ();
11158
11159 return sm;
11160 }
11161
11162 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
11163 until(location)/advance commands. */
11164
11165 static int
11166 until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11167 struct thread_info *tp)
11168 {
11169 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11170
11171 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11172 sm->location_breakpoint) != NULL
11173 || (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL
11174 && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11175 sm->caller_breakpoint) != NULL))
11176 thread_fsm_set_finished (self);
11177
11178 return 1;
11179 }
11180
11181 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
11182 until(location)/advance commands. */
11183
11184 static void
11185 until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11186 struct thread_info *thread)
11187 {
11188 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11189
11190 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
11191 if (sm->location_breakpoint != NULL)
11192 {
11193 delete_breakpoint (sm->location_breakpoint);
11194 sm->location_breakpoint = NULL;
11195 }
11196 if (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL)
11197 {
11198 delete_breakpoint (sm->caller_breakpoint);
11199 sm->caller_breakpoint = NULL;
11200 }
11201 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (sm->thread);
11202 }
11203
11204 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11205 until(location)/advance commands. */
11206
11207 static enum async_reply_reason
11208 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self)
11209 {
11210 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11211 }
11212
11213 void
11214 until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11215 {
11216 struct frame_info *frame;
11217 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11218 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11219 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11220 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11221 int thread;
11222 struct thread_info *tp;
11223 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11224
11225 clear_proceed_status (0);
11226
11227 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11228 this function. */
11229
11230 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11231
11232 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
11233 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
11234 ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
11235 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11236 get_last_displayed_line ())
11237 : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11238 NULL, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0));
11239
11240 if (sals.size () != 1)
11241 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11242
11243 symtab_and_line &sal = sals[0];
11244
11245 if (*arg)
11246 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11247
11248 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11249
11250 tp = inferior_thread ();
11251 thread = tp->global_num;
11252
11253 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11254
11255 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11256 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11257 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11258 that. */
11259
11260 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11261 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11262 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11263 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11264
11265 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11266 one. */
11267
11268 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
11269 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11270 {
11271 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11272 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11273
11274 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11275 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11276 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11277 caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
11278 sal2,
11279 caller_frame_id,
11280 bp_until);
11281
11282 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11283 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11284 }
11285
11286 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11287 frame = NULL;
11288
11289 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
11290 if (anywhere)
11291 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11292 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11293 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11294 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11295 else
11296 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11297 only at the very same frame. */
11298 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11299 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11300
11301 sm = new_until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11302 std::move (location_breakpoint),
11303 std::move (caller_breakpoint));
11304 tp->thread_fsm = &sm->thread_fsm;
11305
11306 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11307
11308 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11309 }
11310
11311 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11312 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11313
11314 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11315 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11316 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11317 if clause in the arg string. */
11318
11319 const char *
11320 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg)
11321 {
11322 const char *cond_string;
11323
11324 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11325 return NULL;
11326
11327 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11328 (*arg) += 2;
11329
11330 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11331 condition string. */
11332 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11333 cond_string = *arg;
11334
11335 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11336 string. */
11337 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11338
11339 return cond_string;
11340 }
11341
11342 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11343 process start/exit, etc. */
11344
11345 typedef enum
11346 {
11347 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11348 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11349 }
11350 catch_fork_kind;
11351
11352 static void
11353 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg_entry, int from_tty,
11354 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11355 {
11356 const char *arg = arg_entry;
11357 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11358 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11359 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11360 int tempflag;
11361
11362 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11363 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11364 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11365
11366 if (!arg)
11367 arg = "";
11368 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11369
11370 /* The allowed syntax is:
11371 catch [v]fork
11372 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11373
11374 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11375 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11376
11377 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11378 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11379
11380 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11381 and enable reporting of such events. */
11382 switch (fork_kind)
11383 {
11384 case catch_fork_temporary:
11385 case catch_fork_permanent:
11386 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11387 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11388 break;
11389 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11390 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11391 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11392 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11393 break;
11394 default:
11395 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11396 break;
11397 }
11398 }
11399
11400 static void
11401 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg_entry, int from_tty,
11402 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11403 {
11404 const char *arg = arg_entry;
11405 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11406 int tempflag;
11407 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11408
11409 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11410
11411 if (!arg)
11412 arg = "";
11413 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11414
11415 /* The allowed syntax is:
11416 catch exec
11417 catch exec if <cond>
11418
11419 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11420 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11421
11422 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11423 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11424
11425 std::unique_ptr<exec_catchpoint> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
11426 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11427 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11428 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11429
11430 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
11431 }
11432
11433 void
11434 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11435 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11436 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11437 const char *addr_string,
11438 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11439 int tempflag,
11440 int enabled,
11441 int from_tty)
11442 {
11443 if (from_tty)
11444 {
11445 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11446 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11447 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11448
11449 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11450 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11451 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11452 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11453 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11454 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11455 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11456 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11457 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11458 enough for now, though. */
11459 }
11460
11461 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11462
11463 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11464 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11465 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11466 language_def (language_ada));
11467 b->language = language_ada;
11468 }
11469
11470 static void
11471 catch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11472 {
11473 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11474 }
11475 \f
11476
11477 static void
11478 tcatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11479 {
11480 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11481 }
11482
11483 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
11484
11485 static int
11486 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11487 {
11488 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
11489 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
11490
11491 if (a->number < b->number)
11492 return -1;
11493 else if (a->number > b->number)
11494 return 1;
11495
11496 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11497 the number 0. */
11498 if (ua < ub)
11499 return -1;
11500 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11501 }
11502
11503 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11504
11505 static void
11506 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11507 {
11508 struct breakpoint *b;
11509 int default_match;
11510 int i;
11511
11512 std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
11513 symtab_and_line last_sal;
11514 gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
11515 if (arg)
11516 {
11517 decoded_sals
11518 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11519 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11520 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11521 default_match = 0;
11522 sals = decoded_sals;
11523 }
11524 else
11525 {
11526 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11527 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11528 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11529 last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
11530 if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
11531 error (_("No source file specified."));
11532
11533 default_match = 1;
11534 sals = last_sal;
11535 }
11536
11537 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11538 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11539 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11540 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11541
11542 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11543 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11544 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11545 due to optimization, all in one block.
11546
11547 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11548 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11549 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11550 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11551 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11552 to support that. */
11553
11554 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11555 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11556 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11557 breakpoint. */
11558
11559 std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
11560 for (const auto &sal : sals)
11561 {
11562 const char *sal_fullname;
11563
11564 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11565 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11566 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11567 or at default pc.
11568
11569 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11570
11571 0 1 pc
11572 1 1 pc _and_ line
11573 0 0 line
11574 1 0 <can't happen> */
11575
11576 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11577 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11578
11579 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11580 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11581 {
11582 int match = 0;
11583 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11584 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11585 {
11586 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11587 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11588 {
11589 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11590 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11591 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11592 && sal.pc
11593 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11594 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11595 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11596 || loc->section == sal.section));
11597 int line_match = 0;
11598
11599 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11600 && loc->symtab != NULL
11601 && sal_fullname != NULL
11602 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11603 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11604 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11605 sal_fullname) == 0)
11606 line_match = 1;
11607
11608 if (pc_match || line_match)
11609 {
11610 match = 1;
11611 break;
11612 }
11613 }
11614 }
11615
11616 if (match)
11617 found.push_back (b);
11618 }
11619 }
11620
11621 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11622 if (found.empty ())
11623 {
11624 if (arg)
11625 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11626 else
11627 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11628 }
11629
11630 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11631 std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
11632 [] (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11633 {
11634 return compare_breakpoints (a, b) < 0;
11635 });
11636 found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
11637 [] (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11638 {
11639 return compare_breakpoints (a, b) == 0;
11640 }),
11641 found.end ());
11642
11643 if (found.size () > 1)
11644 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11645 if (from_tty)
11646 {
11647 if (found.size () == 1)
11648 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11649 else
11650 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11651 }
11652
11653 for (breakpoint *iter : found)
11654 {
11655 if (from_tty)
11656 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter->number);
11657 delete_breakpoint (iter);
11658 }
11659 if (from_tty)
11660 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11661 }
11662 \f
11663 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11664 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11665 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11666
11667 void
11668 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11669 {
11670 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11671
11672 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11673 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11674 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11675 && bs->stop)
11676 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11677
11678 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11679 {
11680 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11681 delete_breakpoint (b);
11682 }
11683 }
11684
11685 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11686 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11687 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
11688 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
11689 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
11690 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
11691
11692 static int
11693 bp_locations_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
11694 {
11695 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
11696 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
11697
11698 if (a->address != b->address)
11699 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
11700
11701 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11702 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11703 grouped. */
11704
11705 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11706 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
11707 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
11708
11709 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11710 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
11711 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
11712
11713 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11714 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11715 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11716
11717 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11718 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
11719 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
11720
11721 return (a > b) - (a < b);
11722 }
11723
11724 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11725 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11726 content of the bp_locations array. */
11727
11728 static void
11729 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11730 {
11731 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
11732
11733 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11734 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11735
11736 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
11737 {
11738 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11739
11740 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11741 continue;
11742
11743 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11744 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11745
11746 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11747 addr = bl->address - start;
11748 if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
11749 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11750
11751 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11752
11753 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11754 addr = end - bl->address;
11755 if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11756 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11757 }
11758 }
11759
11760 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11761
11762 static void
11763 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11764 {
11765 struct breakpoint *b;
11766 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
11767
11768 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
11769
11770 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
11771 {
11772 struct bp_location *bl;
11773 struct tracepoint *t;
11774 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
11775
11776 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11777 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11778 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11779 continue;
11780
11781 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
11782 {
11783 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11784 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
11785 else
11786 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
11787 }
11788
11789 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
11790 break;
11791
11792 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
11793 {
11794 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11795 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11796 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11797 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11798 continue;
11799
11800 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11801
11802 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11803
11804 bl->inserted = 1;
11805 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
11806 }
11807 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
11808 t->number_on_target = b->number;
11809 if (bp_location_downloaded)
11810 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
11811 }
11812 }
11813
11814 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11815
11816 static void
11817 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11818 {
11819 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11820 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11821 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11822 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11823
11824 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11825 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11826 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11827 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11828 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11829
11830 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11831 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11832 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11833 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11834 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11835 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11836 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11837 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11838 }
11839
11840 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11841 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11842 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11843 the target. */
11844
11845 static void
11846 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11847 {
11848 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
11849 struct bp_location *loc;
11850 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11851 int pspace_num;
11852
11853 address = bl->address;
11854 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11855
11856 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11857 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11858 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11859 side. */
11860 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11861 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11862 return;
11863
11864 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11865 the same program space as the location
11866 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11867 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11868 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
11869 {
11870 loc = *loc2p;
11871
11872 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11873 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11874 continue;
11875
11876 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11877 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11878 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11879 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11880 that have already been marked. */
11881 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11882
11883 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11884 it later on. */
11885 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
11886 }
11887 }
11888 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11889 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11890 locations are duplicate of which.
11891
11892 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11893 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11894 info. */
11895
11896 static void
11897 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11898 {
11899 struct breakpoint *b;
11900 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
11901 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11902 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11903 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11904 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11905
11906 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11907 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11908 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11909 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11910 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11911 once. */
11912 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11913 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11914 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11915 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11916
11917 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11918 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11919 struct bp_location **old_locp;
11920 unsigned old_locations_count;
11921 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<struct bp_location *> old_locations (bp_locations);
11922
11923 old_locations_count = bp_locations_count;
11924 bp_locations = NULL;
11925 bp_locations_count = 0;
11926
11927 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11928 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11929 bp_locations_count++;
11930
11931 bp_locations = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_locations_count);
11932 locp = bp_locations;
11933 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11934 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11935 *locp++ = loc;
11936 qsort (bp_locations, bp_locations_count, sizeof (*bp_locations),
11937 bp_locations_compare);
11938
11939 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11940
11941 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11942 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11943 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11944 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11945 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11946 location.
11947
11948 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11949 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11950
11951 locp = bp_locations;
11952 for (old_locp = old_locations.get ();
11953 old_locp < old_locations.get () + old_locations_count;
11954 old_locp++)
11955 {
11956 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
11957 struct bp_location **loc2p;
11958
11959 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11960 not, we have to free it. */
11961 int found_object = 0;
11962 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11963 int keep_in_target = 0;
11964 int removed = 0;
11965
11966 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11967 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11968 while (locp < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11969 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
11970 locp++;
11971
11972 for (loc2p = locp;
11973 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11974 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11975 loc2p++)
11976 {
11977 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11978 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11979 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11980 place there. */
11981 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
11982 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
11983 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
11984 {
11985 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
11986 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
11987 }
11988
11989 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
11990 found_object = 1;
11991 }
11992
11993 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11994 have to go through updates again. */
11995 last_addr = old_loc->address;
11996
11997 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11998 if (!found_object)
11999 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
12000
12001 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
12002 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
12003 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
12004 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
12005 at certain location is not inserted. */
12006
12007 if (old_loc->inserted)
12008 {
12009 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
12010 it. */
12011
12012 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
12013 {
12014 /* The location is still present in the location list,
12015 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
12016 keep_in_target = 1;
12017 }
12018 else
12019 {
12020 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
12021 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
12022 remove its target-side condition. */
12023
12024 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
12025 disabled. See if there's another location at the
12026 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
12027 this one from the target. */
12028
12029 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
12030 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
12031 {
12032 for (loc2p = locp;
12033 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
12034 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12035 loc2p++)
12036 {
12037 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
12038
12039 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
12040 {
12041 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
12042 access watchpoints, if the former are not
12043 supported, but the latter are. */
12044 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
12045 {
12046 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
12047 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
12048 }
12049
12050 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
12051 if it should be inserted in case it will be
12052 unduplicated. */
12053 if (loc2 != old_loc
12054 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
12055 {
12056 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
12057 keep_in_target = 1;
12058 break;
12059 }
12060 }
12061 }
12062 }
12063 }
12064
12065 if (!keep_in_target)
12066 {
12067 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
12068 {
12069 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
12070 this location on the global list, and try to
12071 remove it next time, but there's no particular
12072 reason why we will succeed next time.
12073
12074 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
12075 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
12076 only after calling us. */
12077 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
12078 "breakpoint %d\n"),
12079 old_loc->owner->number);
12080 }
12081 removed = 1;
12082 }
12083 }
12084
12085 if (!found_object)
12086 {
12087 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
12088 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
12089 {
12090 /* This location was removed from the target. In
12091 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
12092 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
12093 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
12094 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
12095 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
12096 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
12097 after we see some number of events. The theory here
12098 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
12099 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
12100 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
12101 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
12102 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
12103 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
12104 SIGTRAP.
12105
12106 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
12107 decr_pc_after_break targets.
12108
12109 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
12110 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
12111 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
12112 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
12113 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
12114 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
12115 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
12116 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
12117 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
12118 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
12119 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
12120 targets that do not support new thread events, like
12121 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
12122 thread_count.
12123
12124 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12125 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12126 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12127 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12128
12129 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12130 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12131 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12132 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12133 traps we can no longer explain. */
12134
12135 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
12136 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12137
12138 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
12139 }
12140 else
12141 {
12142 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12143 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12144 }
12145 }
12146 }
12147
12148 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12149 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12150 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12151 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12152 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12153 are sorted first for the same address.
12154
12155 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12156 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12157
12158 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12159 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12160 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12161 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12162 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12163 {
12164 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12165 non-NULL. */
12166 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12167 b = loc->owner;
12168
12169 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12170 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12171 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12172 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12173 `struct bp_location'. */
12174 || is_tracepoint (b))
12175 {
12176 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12177 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12178 continue;
12179 }
12180
12181 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12182 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12183 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12184 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12185 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12186 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12187 else
12188 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12189
12190 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12191 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12192 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12193 {
12194 *loc_first_p = loc;
12195 loc->duplicate = 0;
12196
12197 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12198 {
12199 loc->needs_update = 1;
12200 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12201 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12202 }
12203 continue;
12204 }
12205
12206
12207 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12208 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12209 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12210 if (loc->inserted)
12211 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12212 loc->duplicate = 1;
12213
12214 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12215 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12216 }
12217
12218 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12219 {
12220 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12221 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12222 else
12223 {
12224 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12225 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12226 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12227 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12228 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12229 "needs_update". */
12230 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12231 }
12232 }
12233
12234 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12235 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12236 }
12237
12238 void
12239 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12240 {
12241 struct bp_location *loc;
12242 int ix;
12243
12244 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
12245 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12246 {
12247 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12248 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
12249 --ix;
12250 }
12251 }
12252
12253 static void
12254 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12255 {
12256
12257 TRY
12258 {
12259 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12260 }
12261 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12262 {
12263 }
12264 END_CATCH
12265 }
12266
12267 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12268
12269 static void
12270 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12271 {
12272 bpstat bs;
12273
12274 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12275 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12276 {
12277 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12278 bs->old_val = NULL;
12279 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12280 }
12281 }
12282
12283 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12284 static int
12285 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12286 {
12287 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12288
12289 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12290 return 0;
12291 }
12292
12293 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12294 callbacks. */
12295
12296 static void
12297 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12298 {
12299 struct value_print_options opts;
12300
12301 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12302
12303 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12304 single string. */
12305 if (b->loc == NULL)
12306 {
12307 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12308 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12309 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12310 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12311 {
12312 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12313 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12314 }
12315 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12316 {
12317 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12318 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12319 b->extra_string);
12320 }
12321 else
12322 {
12323 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12324 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12325 b->extra_string);
12326 }
12327 }
12328 else
12329 {
12330 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12331 {
12332 printf_filtered (" at ");
12333 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12334 gdb_stdout);
12335 }
12336 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12337 {
12338 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12339 more nicely. */
12340 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12341 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12342 symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12343 b->loc->line_number);
12344 else
12345 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12346 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12347 real situation somewhat. */
12348 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12349 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12350 }
12351
12352 if (b->loc->next)
12353 {
12354 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12355 int n = 0;
12356 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12357 ++n;
12358 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12359 }
12360 }
12361 }
12362
12363 /* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
12364
12365 static void
12366 bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
12367 {
12368 xfree (self->function_name);
12369 }
12370
12371 static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
12372 {
12373 bp_location_dtor
12374 };
12375
12376 /* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
12377
12378 breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
12379 {
12380 xfree (this->cond_string);
12381 xfree (this->extra_string);
12382 xfree (this->filter);
12383 }
12384
12385 static struct bp_location *
12386 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12387 {
12388 return new bp_location (&bp_location_ops, self);
12389 }
12390
12391 static void
12392 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12393 {
12394 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12395 }
12396
12397 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12398 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12399
12400 static int
12401 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12402 {
12403 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12404 }
12405
12406 static int
12407 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12408 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12409 {
12410 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12411 }
12412
12413 static int
12414 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12415 const address_space *aspace,
12416 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12417 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12418 {
12419 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12420 }
12421
12422 static void
12423 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12424 {
12425 /* Always stop. */
12426 }
12427
12428 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12429 errors. */
12430
12431 static int
12432 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12433 {
12434 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12435 }
12436
12437 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12438 errors. */
12439
12440 static int
12441 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12442 {
12443 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12444 }
12445
12446 static enum print_stop_action
12447 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12448 {
12449 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12450 }
12451
12452 static void
12453 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12454 struct ui_out *uiout)
12455 {
12456 /* nothing */
12457 }
12458
12459 static void
12460 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12461 {
12462 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12463 }
12464
12465 static void
12466 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12467 {
12468 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12469 }
12470
12471 static void
12472 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12473 (const struct event_location *location,
12474 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12475 enum bptype type_wanted)
12476 {
12477 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12478 }
12479
12480 static void
12481 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12482 struct linespec_result *c,
12483 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12484 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12485 enum bptype type_wanted,
12486 enum bpdisp disposition,
12487 int thread,
12488 int task, int ignore_count,
12489 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12490 int from_tty, int enabled,
12491 int internal, unsigned flags)
12492 {
12493 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12494 }
12495
12496 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12497 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12498 const struct event_location *location,
12499 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12500 {
12501 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12502 }
12503
12504 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12505
12506 static int
12507 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12508 {
12509 return 1;
12510 }
12511
12512 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12513
12514 static void
12515 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12516 {
12517 /* Nothing to do. */
12518 }
12519
12520 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12521 {
12522 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12523 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12524 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12525 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12526 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12527 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12528 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12529 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12530 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12531 NULL,
12532 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12533 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12534 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12535 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12536 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12537 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12538 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12539 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12540 };
12541
12542 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12543
12544 static void
12545 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12546 {
12547 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12548 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
12549 {
12550 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12551 delete_breakpoint (b);
12552 return;
12553 }
12554
12555 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12556 }
12557
12558 static int
12559 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12560 {
12561 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
12562
12563 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
12564 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
12565
12566 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12567 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12568 else
12569 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12570 }
12571
12572 static int
12573 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12574 {
12575 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12576 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12577 else
12578 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
12579 }
12580
12581 static int
12582 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12583 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12584 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12585 {
12586 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12587 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12588 return 0;
12589
12590 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12591 aspace, bp_addr))
12592 return 0;
12593
12594 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12595 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12596 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12597 return 0;
12598
12599 return 1;
12600 }
12601
12602 static int
12603 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12604 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12605 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12606 {
12607 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
12608 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12609 {
12610 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12611 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12612 be set at the same address. */
12613 return 0;
12614 }
12615
12616 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
12617 }
12618
12619 static int
12620 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12621 {
12622 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12623
12624 return 1;
12625 }
12626
12627 static enum print_stop_action
12628 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12629 {
12630 struct breakpoint *b;
12631 const struct bp_location *bl;
12632 int bp_temp;
12633 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12634
12635 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12636
12637 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
12638 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12639
12640 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12641 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12642 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12643 bl->address,
12644 b->number, 1);
12645 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12646 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
12647
12648 if (bp_temp)
12649 uiout->text ("Temporary breakpoint ");
12650 else
12651 uiout->text ("Breakpoint ");
12652 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12653 {
12654 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12655 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12656 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12657 }
12658 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
12659 uiout->text (", ");
12660
12661 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12662 }
12663
12664 static void
12665 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12666 {
12667 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12668 return;
12669
12670 switch (b->type)
12671 {
12672 case bp_breakpoint:
12673 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12674 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12675 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12676 else
12677 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12678 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12679 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12680 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12681 break;
12682 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12683 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12684 break;
12685 case bp_dprintf:
12686 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12687 break;
12688 }
12689
12690 say_where (b);
12691 }
12692
12693 static void
12694 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12695 {
12696 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12697 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
12698 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12699 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
12700 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12701 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12702 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
12703 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12704 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
12705 else
12706 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12707 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12708
12709 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12710 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
12711
12712 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12713 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12714 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
12715 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
12716
12717 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12718 }
12719
12720 static void
12721 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12722 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12723 enum bptype type_wanted)
12724 {
12725 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12726 }
12727
12728 static void
12729 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12730 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12731 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12732 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12733 enum bptype type_wanted,
12734 enum bpdisp disposition,
12735 int thread,
12736 int task, int ignore_count,
12737 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12738 int from_tty, int enabled,
12739 int internal, unsigned flags)
12740 {
12741 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12742 std::move (cond_string),
12743 std::move (extra_string),
12744 type_wanted,
12745 disposition, thread, task,
12746 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12747 enabled, internal, flags);
12748 }
12749
12750 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12751 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12752 const struct event_location *location,
12753 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12754 {
12755 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12756 }
12757
12758 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12759
12760 static void
12761 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12762 {
12763 switch (b->type)
12764 {
12765 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12766 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12767 case bp_overlay_event:
12768 case bp_longjmp_master:
12769 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12770 case bp_exception_master:
12771 delete_breakpoint (b);
12772 break;
12773
12774 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12775 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12776 case bp_shlib_event:
12777
12778 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12779 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12780 case bp_thread_event:
12781 break;
12782 }
12783 }
12784
12785 static void
12786 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12787 {
12788 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12789 {
12790 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12791 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12792 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12793 objects (among other things). */
12794 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12795 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12796 }
12797 else
12798 bs->stop = 0;
12799 }
12800
12801 static enum print_stop_action
12802 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12803 {
12804 struct breakpoint *b;
12805
12806 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12807
12808 switch (b->type)
12809 {
12810 case bp_shlib_event:
12811 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12812 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12813 to shlib event" message.) */
12814 print_solib_event (0);
12815 break;
12816
12817 case bp_thread_event:
12818 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12819 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12820 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12821 break;
12822
12823 case bp_overlay_event:
12824 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12825 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12826 break;
12827
12828 case bp_longjmp_master:
12829 /* These should never be enabled. */
12830 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12831 break;
12832
12833 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12834 /* These should never be enabled. */
12835 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12836 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12837 break;
12838
12839 case bp_exception_master:
12840 /* These should never be enabled. */
12841 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12842 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12843 break;
12844 }
12845
12846 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12847 }
12848
12849 static void
12850 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12851 {
12852 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12853 }
12854
12855 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12856
12857 static void
12858 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12859 {
12860 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12861 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12862 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12863 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12864 }
12865
12866 static void
12867 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12868 {
12869 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12870 }
12871
12872 static enum print_stop_action
12873 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12874 {
12875 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12876 }
12877
12878 static void
12879 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12880 {
12881 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12882 }
12883
12884 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12885
12886 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12887 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12888
12889 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12890 {
12891 thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
12892
12893 if (tp != NULL)
12894 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12895 }
12896
12897 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12898
12899 static int
12900 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12901 {
12902 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12903
12904 if (v == 0)
12905 {
12906 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12907 if needed. */
12908 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore != NULL)
12909 bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
12910 bl->probe.objfile,
12911 bl->gdbarch);
12912 }
12913
12914 return v;
12915 }
12916
12917 static int
12918 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12919 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12920 {
12921 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12922 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore != NULL)
12923 bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
12924 bl->probe.objfile,
12925 bl->gdbarch);
12926
12927 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
12928 }
12929
12930 static void
12931 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12932 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12933 enum bptype type_wanted)
12934 {
12935 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12936
12937 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
12938 lsal.canonical
12939 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12940 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12941 }
12942
12943 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12944 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12945 const struct event_location *location,
12946 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12947 {
12948 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
12949 if (sals.empty ())
12950 error (_("probe not found"));
12951 return sals;
12952 }
12953
12954 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12955
12956 static void
12957 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12958 {
12959 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12960 }
12961
12962 static int
12963 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12964 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12965 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12966 {
12967 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12968 tracepoints. */
12969 return 0;
12970 }
12971
12972 static void
12973 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12974 struct ui_out *uiout)
12975 {
12976 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12977 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id)
12978 {
12979 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
12980
12981 uiout->text ("\tmarker id is ");
12982 uiout->field_string ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12983 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
12984 uiout->text ("\n");
12985 }
12986 }
12987
12988 static void
12989 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12990 {
12991 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12992 return;
12993
12994 switch (b->type)
12995 {
12996 case bp_tracepoint:
12997 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
12998 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12999 break;
13000 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
13001 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
13002 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13003 break;
13004 case bp_static_tracepoint:
13005 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
13006 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13007 break;
13008 default:
13009 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13010 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
13011 }
13012
13013 say_where (b);
13014 }
13015
13016 static void
13017 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
13018 {
13019 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13020
13021 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
13022 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
13023 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
13024 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
13025 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
13026 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
13027 else
13028 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13029 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
13030
13031 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
13032 event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
13033 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
13034
13035 if (tp->pass_count)
13036 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
13037 }
13038
13039 static void
13040 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13041 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13042 enum bptype type_wanted)
13043 {
13044 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13045 }
13046
13047 static void
13048 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13049 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13050 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13051 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13052 enum bptype type_wanted,
13053 enum bpdisp disposition,
13054 int thread,
13055 int task, int ignore_count,
13056 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13057 int from_tty, int enabled,
13058 int internal, unsigned flags)
13059 {
13060 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13061 std::move (cond_string),
13062 std::move (extra_string),
13063 type_wanted,
13064 disposition, thread, task,
13065 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13066 enabled, internal, flags);
13067 }
13068
13069 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13070 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13071 const struct event_location *location,
13072 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13073 {
13074 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
13075 }
13076
13077 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
13078
13079 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
13080 static probe. */
13081
13082 static void
13083 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
13084 (const struct event_location *location,
13085 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13086 enum bptype type_wanted)
13087 {
13088 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13089 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13090 }
13091
13092 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13093 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13094 const struct event_location *location,
13095 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13096 {
13097 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13098 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13099 }
13100
13101 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
13102
13103 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
13104
13105 static void
13106 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13107 {
13108 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13109
13110 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
13111 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
13112
13113 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
13114 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
13115 3 - disconnect from target 1
13116 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
13117
13118 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
13119 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
13120 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
13121 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
13122 it all the time. */
13123 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
13124 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
13125 }
13126
13127 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
13128
13129 static void
13130 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13131 {
13132 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
13133 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
13134 tp->extra_string);
13135 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13136 }
13137
13138 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
13139 dprintf.
13140
13141 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
13142 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
13143 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
13144 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13145 address are all handled. */
13146
13147 static void
13148 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13149 {
13150 struct bpstats tmp_bs;
13151 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13152
13153 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13154 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13155 condition not be evaluated. */
13156 bs->stop = 0;
13157
13158 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13159 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13160 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13161 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13162 commands here throws. */
13163 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13164 bs->commands = NULL;
13165
13166 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13167
13168 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13169 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13170 list. */
13171 }
13172
13173 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13174 markers (`-m'). */
13175
13176 static void
13177 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13178 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13179 enum bptype type_wanted)
13180 {
13181 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13182 const char *arg_start, *arg;
13183
13184 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location);
13185 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
13186
13187 std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
13188 const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
13189 canonical->location = new_linespec_location (&ptr);
13190
13191 lsal.canonical
13192 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
13193 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
13194 }
13195
13196 static void
13197 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13198 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13199 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13200 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13201 enum bptype type_wanted,
13202 enum bpdisp disposition,
13203 int thread,
13204 int task, int ignore_count,
13205 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13206 int from_tty, int enabled,
13207 int internal, unsigned flags)
13208 {
13209 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
13210
13211 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13212 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13213 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13214 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13215 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13216 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13217
13218 for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
13219 {
13220 event_location_up location
13221 = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
13222
13223 std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
13224 init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
13225 std::move (location), NULL,
13226 std::move (cond_string),
13227 std::move (extra_string),
13228 type_wanted, disposition,
13229 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13230 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13231 canonical->special_display);
13232 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13233 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13234 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13235 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13236 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13237 corresponds to this one */
13238 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13239
13240 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
13241 }
13242 }
13243
13244 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13245 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13246 const struct event_location *location,
13247 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13248 {
13249 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13250 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location);
13251
13252 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13253 if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13254 {
13255 sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13256 sals.resize (1);
13257 return sals;
13258 }
13259 else
13260 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13261 }
13262
13263 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13264
13265 static int
13266 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13267 {
13268 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13269 }
13270
13271 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13272 structures. */
13273
13274 void
13275 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13276 {
13277 struct breakpoint *b;
13278
13279 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13280
13281 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13282 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13283 especial culprits.
13284
13285 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13286 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13287 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13288 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13289 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13290 deleted.
13291
13292 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13293 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13294 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13295 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13296 was chosen. */
13297 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13298 return;
13299
13300 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13301 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13302 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13303 {
13304 struct breakpoint *related;
13305 struct watchpoint *w;
13306
13307 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13308 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13309 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13310 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13311 else
13312 w = NULL;
13313 if (w != NULL)
13314 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13315
13316 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13317 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13318 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13319 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13320 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13321 }
13322
13323 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13324 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13325 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13326 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13327 if (bpt->number)
13328 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt);
13329
13330 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13331 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13332
13333 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13334 if (b->next == bpt)
13335 {
13336 b->next = bpt->next;
13337 break;
13338 }
13339
13340 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13341 been freed. */
13342 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13343 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13344 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13345 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13346 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13347 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13348 commands won't work. */
13349
13350 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13351
13352 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13353 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13354 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13355 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13356 might be better design to have location completely
13357 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13358 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13359
13360 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13361 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13362 bpt->type = bp_none;
13363 delete bpt;
13364 }
13365
13366 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13367 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13368
13369 static void
13370 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13371 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13372 {
13373 struct breakpoint *related;
13374
13375 related = b;
13376 do
13377 {
13378 struct breakpoint *next;
13379
13380 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13381 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13382
13383 if (next == related)
13384 {
13385 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13386 function (related);
13387
13388 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13389 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13390 out. */
13391 break;
13392 }
13393 else
13394 function (related);
13395
13396 related = next;
13397 }
13398 while (related != b);
13399 }
13400
13401 static void
13402 delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
13403 {
13404 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13405
13406 dont_repeat ();
13407
13408 if (arg == 0)
13409 {
13410 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13411
13412 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13413 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13414 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13415 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13416 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13417 {
13418 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13419 break;
13420 }
13421
13422 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13423 if (!from_tty
13424 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13425 {
13426 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13427 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13428 delete_breakpoint (b);
13429 }
13430 }
13431 else
13432 map_breakpoint_numbers
13433 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
13434 {
13435 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, delete_breakpoint);
13436 });
13437 }
13438
13439 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
13440 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
13441 considered. */
13442
13443 static int
13444 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13445 {
13446 struct bp_location *loc;
13447
13448 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
13449 if ((pspace == NULL
13450 || loc->pspace == pspace)
13451 && !loc->shlib_disabled
13452 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13453 return 0;
13454 return 1;
13455 }
13456
13457 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13458 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13459 Null names are ignored. */
13460
13461 static int
13462 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13463 {
13464 struct bp_location *l;
13465 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
13466 (int (*) (const void *,
13467 const void *)) streq,
13468 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
13469
13470 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13471 {
13472 const char **slot;
13473 const char *name = l->function_name;
13474
13475 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13476 if (name == NULL)
13477 continue;
13478
13479 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
13480 INSERT);
13481 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13482 returns NULL. */
13483 if (*slot != NULL)
13484 {
13485 htab_delete (htab);
13486 return 1;
13487 }
13488 *slot = name;
13489 }
13490
13491 htab_delete (htab);
13492 return 0;
13493 }
13494
13495 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13496 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13497 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13498 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13499 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13500 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13501 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13502 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13503 The heuristic is:
13504
13505 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13506 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13507 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13508 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13509 in the sources, and output a warning.
13510
13511 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13512 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13513 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13514 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13515 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13516 warning.
13517
13518 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13519 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13520 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13521 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13522 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13523 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13524 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13525 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13526 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13527
13528 static struct symtab_and_line
13529 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13530 {
13531 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13532 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13533 CORE_ADDR pc;
13534
13535 pc = sal.pc;
13536 if (sal.line)
13537 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13538
13539 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13540 {
13541 if (strcmp (tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
13542 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13543 b->number,
13544 tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
13545
13546 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13547 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
13548 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
13549
13550 return sal;
13551 }
13552
13553 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13554 by string ID. */
13555 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13556 && sal.line != 0
13557 && sal.symtab != NULL
13558 && tp->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
13559 {
13560 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
13561
13562 markers
13563 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13564
13565 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
13566 {
13567 struct symbol *sym;
13568 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13569 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13570 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
13571
13572 tpmarker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
13573
13574 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13575 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (tpmarker->str_id);
13576
13577 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13578 "found at previous line number"),
13579 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13580
13581 symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13582 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13583 uiout->text ("Now in ");
13584 if (sym)
13585 {
13586 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
13587 uiout->text (" at ");
13588 }
13589 uiout->field_string ("file",
13590 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13591 uiout->text (":");
13592
13593 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
13594 {
13595 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13596
13597 uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
13598 }
13599
13600 uiout->field_int ("line", sal2.line);
13601 uiout->text ("\n");
13602
13603 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13604 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
13605
13606 b->location.reset (NULL);
13607 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13608 explicit_loc.source_filename
13609 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13610 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
13611 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
13612 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13613
13614 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13615 so. */
13616
13617 release_static_tracepoint_marker (tpmarker);
13618 }
13619 }
13620 return sal;
13621 }
13622
13623 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13624 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13625
13626 static int
13627 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
13628 {
13629 while (a && b)
13630 {
13631 if (a->address != b->address)
13632 return 0;
13633
13634 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
13635 return 0;
13636
13637 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
13638 return 0;
13639
13640 a = a->next;
13641 b = b->next;
13642 }
13643
13644 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
13645 return 0;
13646
13647 return 1;
13648 }
13649
13650 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
13651 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
13652 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
13653
13654 static struct bp_location *
13655 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13656 {
13657 struct bp_location head;
13658 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
13659 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
13660 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
13661
13662 if (pspace == NULL)
13663 {
13664 i = b->loc;
13665 b->loc = NULL;
13666 return i;
13667 }
13668
13669 head.next = NULL;
13670
13671 while (i != NULL)
13672 {
13673 if (i->pspace == pspace)
13674 {
13675 *i_link = i->next;
13676 i->next = NULL;
13677 hoisted->next = i;
13678 hoisted = i;
13679 }
13680 else
13681 i_link = &i->next;
13682 i = *i_link;
13683 }
13684
13685 return head.next;
13686 }
13687
13688 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
13689 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
13690 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
13691 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
13692 untouched. */
13693
13694 void
13695 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
13696 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
13697 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
13698 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
13699 {
13700 int i;
13701 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
13702
13703 if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
13704 {
13705 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13706 location. */
13707 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13708 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13709 "multiple locations found\n"),
13710 b->number);
13711 return;
13712 }
13713
13714 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13715 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13716 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13717 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13718 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13719 individual locations. */
13720 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
13721 return;
13722
13723 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
13724
13725 for (const auto &sal : sals)
13726 {
13727 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13728
13729 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
13730
13731 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
13732
13733 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13734 old symtab. */
13735 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13736 {
13737 const char *s;
13738
13739 s = b->cond_string;
13740 TRY
13741 {
13742 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
13743 block_for_pc (sal.pc),
13744 0);
13745 }
13746 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13747 {
13748 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
13749 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
13750 b->number, e.message);
13751 new_loc->enabled = 0;
13752 }
13753 END_CATCH
13754 }
13755
13756 if (!sals_end.empty ())
13757 {
13758 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
13759
13760 new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
13761 }
13762 }
13763
13764 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13765 breakpoints. */
13766 {
13767 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13768 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13769 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13770 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13771 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13772 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13773 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13774
13775 for (; e; e = e->next)
13776 {
13777 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
13778 {
13779 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
13780 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13781 {
13782 for (; l; l = l->next)
13783 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
13784 {
13785 l->enabled = 0;
13786 break;
13787 }
13788 }
13789 else
13790 {
13791 for (; l; l = l->next)
13792 if (l->function_name
13793 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
13794 {
13795 l->enabled = 0;
13796 break;
13797 }
13798 }
13799 }
13800 }
13801 }
13802
13803 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13804 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
13805 }
13806
13807 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13808 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13809
13810 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13811 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
13812 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
13813 {
13814 struct gdb_exception exception = exception_none;
13815
13816 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13817
13818 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
13819
13820 TRY
13821 {
13822 sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13823 }
13824 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13825 {
13826 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13827
13828 exception = e;
13829
13830 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13831 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13832 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13833 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13834 state, then user already saw the message about that
13835 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13836 errors. */
13837 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13838 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13839 || (b->loc != NULL
13840 && search_pspace != NULL
13841 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
13842 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13843 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13844 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13845 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13846
13847 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13848 {
13849 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13850 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13851 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13852 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13853 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13854 which approach is better. */
13855 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13856 throw_exception (e);
13857 }
13858 }
13859 END_CATCH
13860
13861 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13862 {
13863 for (auto &sal : sals)
13864 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
13865 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
13866 {
13867 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
13868 int thread, task;
13869
13870 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals[0].pc,
13871 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
13872 &extra_string);
13873 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
13874 if (cond_string)
13875 b->cond_string = cond_string;
13876 b->thread = thread;
13877 b->task = task;
13878 if (extra_string)
13879 {
13880 xfree (b->extra_string);
13881 b->extra_string = extra_string;
13882 }
13883 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13884 }
13885
13886 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13887 sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
13888
13889 *found = 1;
13890 }
13891 else
13892 *found = 0;
13893
13894 return sals;
13895 }
13896
13897 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13898 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13899 locations. */
13900
13901 static void
13902 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13903 {
13904 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
13905 std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
13906
13907 int found;
13908 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
13909 filter_pspace, &found);
13910 if (found)
13911 expanded = std::move (sals);
13912
13913 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
13914 {
13915 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
13916 = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
13917 filter_pspace, &found);
13918 if (found)
13919 expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
13920 }
13921
13922 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
13923 }
13924
13925 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13926 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13927
13928 static void
13929 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
13930 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13931 enum bptype type_wanted)
13932 {
13933 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
13934 }
13935
13936 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13937 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13938 breakpoint_ops. */
13939
13940 static void
13941 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13942 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13943 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13944 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13945 enum bptype type_wanted,
13946 enum bpdisp disposition,
13947 int thread,
13948 int task, int ignore_count,
13949 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13950 int from_tty, int enabled,
13951 int internal, unsigned flags)
13952 {
13953 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
13954 std::move (cond_string),
13955 std::move (extra_string),
13956 type_wanted, disposition,
13957 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13958 enabled, internal, flags);
13959 }
13960
13961 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13962 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13963
13964 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13965 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
13966 const struct event_location *location,
13967 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13968 {
13969 struct linespec_result canonical;
13970
13971 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
13972 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
13973 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13974 b->filter);
13975
13976 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13977 gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
13978
13979 if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
13980 {
13981 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
13982 return std::move (lsal.sals);
13983 }
13984 return {};
13985 }
13986
13987 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13988
13989 static void
13990 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
13991 {
13992 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13993 set_language (b->language);
13994
13995 b->ops->re_set (b);
13996 }
13997
13998 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13999 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
14000
14001 void
14002 breakpoint_re_set (void)
14003 {
14004 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14005
14006 {
14007 scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
14008 scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
14009 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
14010
14011 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
14012 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
14013 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
14014 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
14015
14016 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14017 {
14018 TRY
14019 {
14020 breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
14021 }
14022 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14023 {
14024 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
14025 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
14026 b->number);
14027 }
14028 END_CATCH
14029 }
14030
14031 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
14032 }
14033
14034 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
14035 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
14036 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
14037 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
14038
14039 /* Now we can insert. */
14040 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14041 }
14042 \f
14043 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
14044
14045 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
14046 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
14047 void
14048 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
14049 {
14050 if (b->thread != -1)
14051 {
14052 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
14053 b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
14054
14055 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
14056 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
14057 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
14058 as well. */
14059 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
14060 }
14061 }
14062
14063 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14064 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14065 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14066
14067 void
14068 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
14069 {
14070 struct breakpoint *b;
14071
14072 if (count < 0)
14073 count = 0;
14074
14075 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14076 if (b->number == bptnum)
14077 {
14078 if (is_tracepoint (b))
14079 {
14080 if (from_tty && count != 0)
14081 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
14082 bptnum);
14083 return;
14084 }
14085
14086 b->ignore_count = count;
14087 if (from_tty)
14088 {
14089 if (count == 0)
14090 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
14091 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
14092 bptnum);
14093 else if (count == 1)
14094 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
14095 bptnum);
14096 else
14097 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
14098 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
14099 count, bptnum);
14100 }
14101 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14102 return;
14103 }
14104
14105 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
14106 }
14107
14108 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
14109
14110 static void
14111 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14112 {
14113 char *p = args;
14114 int num;
14115
14116 if (p == 0)
14117 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
14118
14119 num = get_number (&p);
14120 if (num == 0)
14121 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
14122 if (*p == 0)
14123 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
14124
14125 set_ignore_count (num,
14126 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14127 from_tty);
14128 if (from_tty)
14129 printf_filtered ("\n");
14130 }
14131 \f
14132
14133 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
14134 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
14135
14136 static void
14137 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
14138 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14139 {
14140 if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
14141 {
14142 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
14143 bp_num_range.first);
14144 }
14145 else
14146 {
14147 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14148
14149 for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
14150 {
14151 bool match = false;
14152
14153 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14154 if (b->number == i)
14155 {
14156 match = true;
14157 function (b);
14158 break;
14159 }
14160 if (!match)
14161 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
14162 }
14163 }
14164 }
14165
14166 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
14167 ARGS. */
14168
14169 static void
14170 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
14171 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14172 {
14173 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14174 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14175
14176 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14177
14178 while (!parser.finished ())
14179 {
14180 int num = parser.get_number ();
14181 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
14182 }
14183 }
14184
14185 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
14186 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
14187
14188 static struct bp_location *
14189 find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
14190 {
14191 struct breakpoint *b;
14192
14193 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14194 if (b->number == bp_num)
14195 {
14196 break;
14197 }
14198
14199 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14200 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
14201
14202 if (loc_num == 0)
14203 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14204
14205 int n = 0;
14206 for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14207 if (++n == loc_num)
14208 return loc;
14209
14210 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14211 }
14212
14213 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
14214 enum class extract_bp_kind
14215 {
14216 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
14217 bp,
14218
14219 /* Extracting a location number. */
14220 loc,
14221 };
14222
14223 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
14224 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
14225 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
14226 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
14227 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
14228
14229 static int
14230 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
14231 int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
14232 {
14233 const char *end = start;
14234 int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
14235 if (num < 0)
14236 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14237 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14238 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14239 int (end - start), start);
14240 if (num == 0)
14241 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14242 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14243 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14244 int (end - start), start);
14245
14246 if (end_out != NULL)
14247 *end_out = end;
14248 return num;
14249 }
14250
14251 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
14252 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
14253 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
14254 are always positive integers. */
14255
14256 static std::pair<int, int>
14257 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
14258 const std::string &arg,
14259 std::string::size_type arg_offset)
14260 {
14261 std::pair<int, int> range;
14262 const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
14263 std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
14264 if (dash != std::string::npos)
14265 {
14266 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
14267 if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
14268 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14269 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
14270 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
14271 bp_loc);
14272
14273 const char *end;
14274 const char *start_first = bp_loc;
14275 const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
14276 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
14277 range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
14278
14279 if (range.first > range.second)
14280 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14281 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
14282 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
14283 int (end - start_first), start_first);
14284 }
14285 else
14286 {
14287 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
14288 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
14289 range.second = range.first;
14290 }
14291 return range;
14292 }
14293
14294 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
14295 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
14296 BP_LOC_RANGE.
14297
14298 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
14299
14300 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
14301 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
14302 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
14303 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
14304 location number range.
14305 */
14306
14307 static void
14308 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
14309 std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
14310 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
14311 {
14312 std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
14313
14314 if (dot != std::string::npos)
14315 {
14316 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
14317
14318 if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
14319 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
14320
14321 bp_num_range.first
14322 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
14323 bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
14324
14325 bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
14326 arg, dot + 1);
14327 }
14328 else
14329 {
14330 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
14331
14332 bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
14333 bp_loc_range.first = 0;
14334 bp_loc_range.second = 0;
14335 }
14336 }
14337
14338 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
14339 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
14340
14341 static void
14342 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
14343 {
14344 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
14345 if (loc != NULL)
14346 {
14347 if (loc->enabled != enable)
14348 {
14349 loc->enabled = enable;
14350 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14351 }
14352 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14353 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14354 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14355 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14356 }
14357 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14358 }
14359
14360 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
14361 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
14362 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
14363 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
14364 location. */
14365
14366 static void
14367 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
14368 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
14369 bool enable)
14370 {
14371 for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
14372 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
14373 }
14374
14375 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14376 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14377 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14378
14379 void
14380 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14381 {
14382 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14383 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14384 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14385 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14386 return;
14387
14388 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14389
14390 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14391 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14392
14393 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14394 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14395 {
14396 struct bp_location *location;
14397
14398 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14399 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14400 }
14401
14402 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14403
14404 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14405 }
14406
14407 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
14408 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
14409 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
14410 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
14411
14412 static void
14413 enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
14414 {
14415 if (args == 0)
14416 {
14417 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14418
14419 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14420 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14421 {
14422 if (enable)
14423 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14424 else
14425 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14426 }
14427 }
14428 else
14429 {
14430 std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
14431
14432 while (!num.empty ())
14433 {
14434 std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
14435
14436 extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
14437
14438 if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
14439 && bp_loc_range.first == 0)
14440 {
14441 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
14442 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
14443 enable
14444 ? enable_breakpoint
14445 : disable_breakpoint);
14446 }
14447 else
14448 {
14449 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
14450 'x.y-z'. */
14451 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
14452 (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
14453 }
14454 num = extract_arg (&args);
14455 }
14456 }
14457 }
14458
14459 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
14460 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
14461 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
14462 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14463
14464 static void
14465 disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14466 {
14467 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
14468 }
14469
14470 static void
14471 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14472 int count)
14473 {
14474 int target_resources_ok;
14475
14476 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14477 {
14478 int i;
14479 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14480 target_resources_ok =
14481 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14482 i + 1, 0);
14483 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14484 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14485 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14486 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14487 }
14488
14489 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14490 {
14491 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14492 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14493
14494 TRY
14495 {
14496 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14497
14498 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14499 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14500 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14501 }
14502 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14503 {
14504 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14505 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14506 bpt->number);
14507 return;
14508 }
14509 END_CATCH
14510 }
14511
14512 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14513
14514 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14515 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14516
14517 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14518 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14519 {
14520 struct bp_location *location;
14521
14522 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14523 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14524 }
14525
14526 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14527 bpt->enable_count = count;
14528 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14529
14530 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14531 }
14532
14533
14534 void
14535 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14536 {
14537 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14538 }
14539
14540 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
14541 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
14542 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
14543 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14544
14545 static void
14546 enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14547 {
14548 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
14549 }
14550
14551 static void
14552 enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14553 {
14554 map_breakpoint_numbers
14555 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14556 {
14557 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14558 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14559 {
14560 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
14561 });
14562 });
14563 }
14564
14565 static void
14566 enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14567 {
14568 int count;
14569
14570 if (args == NULL)
14571 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14572
14573 count = get_number (&args);
14574
14575 map_breakpoint_numbers
14576 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14577 {
14578 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14579 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14580 {
14581 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
14582 });
14583 });
14584 }
14585
14586 static void
14587 enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14588 {
14589 map_breakpoint_numbers
14590 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14591 {
14592 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14593 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14594 {
14595 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
14596 });
14597 });
14598 }
14599 \f
14600 static void
14601 set_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14602 {
14603 }
14604
14605 static void
14606 show_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14607 {
14608 }
14609
14610 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14611 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14612 GDB itself. */
14613
14614 static void
14615 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14616 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14617 const bfd_byte *data)
14618 {
14619 struct breakpoint *bp;
14620
14621 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14622 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14623 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14624 {
14625 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14626
14627 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val)
14628 {
14629 struct bp_location *loc;
14630
14631 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14632 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14633 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14634 && addr + len > loc->address)
14635 {
14636 value_free (wp->val);
14637 wp->val = NULL;
14638 wp->val_valid = 0;
14639 }
14640 }
14641 }
14642 }
14643
14644 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14645
14646 void
14647 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14648 const address_space *aspace,
14649 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14650 {
14651 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14652 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14653 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14654
14655 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14656 {
14657 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14658 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
14659 }
14660
14661 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14662 sal.pc = pc;
14663 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14664 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14665 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14666
14667 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14668 }
14669
14670 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
14671
14672 int
14673 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
14674 {
14675 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
14676 std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
14677
14678 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
14679
14680 if (!next_pcs.empty ())
14681 {
14682 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
14683 const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
14684
14685 for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
14686 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
14687
14688 return 1;
14689 }
14690 else
14691 return 0;
14692 }
14693
14694 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14695
14696 int
14697 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
14698 const address_space *aspace,
14699 CORE_ADDR pc)
14700 {
14701 struct bp_location *loc;
14702
14703 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14704 if (loc->inserted
14705 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
14706 return 1;
14707
14708 return 0;
14709 }
14710
14711 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14712 PC. */
14713
14714 int
14715 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
14716 CORE_ADDR pc)
14717 {
14718 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14719
14720 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14721 {
14722 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14723 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14724 return 1;
14725 }
14726 return 0;
14727 }
14728
14729 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14730
14731 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14732 static void
14733 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14734 {
14735 tracepoint_count = num;
14736 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14737 }
14738
14739 static void
14740 trace_command (char *arg_in, int from_tty)
14741 {
14742 const char *arg = arg_in;
14743 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14744
14745 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14746 current_language);
14747 if (location != NULL
14748 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
14749 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
14750 else
14751 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14752
14753 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14754 location.get (),
14755 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14756 0 /* tempflag */,
14757 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14758 0 /* Ignore count */,
14759 pending_break_support,
14760 ops,
14761 from_tty,
14762 1 /* enabled */,
14763 0 /* internal */, 0);
14764 }
14765
14766 static void
14767 ftrace_command (char *arg_in, int from_tty)
14768 {
14769 const char *arg = arg_in;
14770 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14771 current_language);
14772 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14773 location.get (),
14774 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14775 0 /* tempflag */,
14776 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14777 0 /* Ignore count */,
14778 pending_break_support,
14779 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14780 from_tty,
14781 1 /* enabled */,
14782 0 /* internal */, 0);
14783 }
14784
14785 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14786
14787 static void
14788 strace_command (char *arg_in, int from_tty)
14789 {
14790 const char *arg = arg_in;
14791 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14792 event_location_up location;
14793
14794 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14795 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14796 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
14797 {
14798 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14799 location = new_linespec_location (&arg);
14800 }
14801 else
14802 {
14803 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14804 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14805 }
14806
14807 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14808 location.get (),
14809 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14810 0 /* tempflag */,
14811 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14812 0 /* Ignore count */,
14813 pending_break_support,
14814 ops,
14815 from_tty,
14816 1 /* enabled */,
14817 0 /* internal */, 0);
14818 }
14819
14820 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14821 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14822
14823 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14824 static int next_cmd;
14825
14826 static char *
14827 read_uploaded_action (void)
14828 {
14829 char *rslt;
14830
14831 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
14832
14833 next_cmd++;
14834
14835 return rslt;
14836 }
14837
14838 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14839 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14840 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14841 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14842 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14843
14844 struct tracepoint *
14845 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14846 {
14847 const char *addr_str;
14848 char small_buf[100];
14849 struct tracepoint *tp;
14850
14851 if (utp->at_string)
14852 addr_str = utp->at_string;
14853 else
14854 {
14855 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14856 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14857 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14858 user. */
14859 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14860 "source location, using raw address"),
14861 utp->number);
14862 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14863 addr_str = small_buf;
14864 }
14865
14866 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14867 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14868 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14869 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14870 utp->number);
14871
14872 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
14873 current_language);
14874 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14875 location.get (),
14876 utp->cond_string, -1, addr_str,
14877 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14878 0 /* tempflag */,
14879 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14880 0 /* Ignore count */,
14881 pending_break_support,
14882 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14883 0 /* from_tty */,
14884 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14885 0 /* internal */,
14886 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14887 return NULL;
14888
14889 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14890 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14891 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14892
14893 if (utp->pass > 0)
14894 {
14895 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
14896 tp->number);
14897
14898 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14899 }
14900
14901 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14902 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14903 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14904 function. */
14905 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
14906 {
14907 command_line_up cmd_list;
14908
14909 this_utp = utp;
14910 next_cmd = 0;
14911
14912 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
14913
14914 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
14915 }
14916 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
14917 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
14918 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14919 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14920 utp->number);
14921
14922 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14923 tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14924 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14925
14926 return tp;
14927 }
14928
14929 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14930 omitted. */
14931
14932 static void
14933 info_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14934 {
14935 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14936 int num_printed;
14937
14938 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
14939
14940 if (num_printed == 0)
14941 {
14942 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14943 uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14944 else
14945 uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14946 }
14947
14948 default_collect_info ();
14949 }
14950
14951 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14952 Not supported by all targets. */
14953 static void
14954 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14955 {
14956 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14957 }
14958
14959 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14960 Not supported by all targets. */
14961 static void
14962 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14963 {
14964 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14965 }
14966
14967 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14968 static void
14969 delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14970 {
14971 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14972
14973 dont_repeat ();
14974
14975 if (arg == 0)
14976 {
14977 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14978
14979 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14980 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14981 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14982 argument. */
14983 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14984 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14985 {
14986 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14987 break;
14988 }
14989
14990 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14991 if (!from_tty
14992 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14993 {
14994 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14995 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14996 delete_breakpoint (b);
14997 }
14998 }
14999 else
15000 map_breakpoint_numbers
15001 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
15002 {
15003 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, delete_breakpoint);
15004 });
15005 }
15006
15007 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
15008
15009 static void
15010 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
15011 {
15012 tp->pass_count = count;
15013 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (tp);
15014 if (from_tty)
15015 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
15016 tp->number, count);
15017 }
15018
15019 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
15020
15021 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
15022 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
15023 Also accepts special argument "all". */
15024
15025 static void
15026 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15027 {
15028 struct tracepoint *t1;
15029 unsigned int count;
15030
15031 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
15032 error (_("passcount command requires an "
15033 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
15034
15035 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
15036
15037 args = skip_spaces (args);
15038 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
15039 {
15040 struct breakpoint *b;
15041
15042 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
15043 if (*args)
15044 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
15045
15046 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15047 {
15048 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15049 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15050 }
15051 }
15052 else if (*args == '\0')
15053 {
15054 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
15055 if (t1)
15056 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15057 }
15058 else
15059 {
15060 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
15061 while (!parser.finished ())
15062 {
15063 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
15064 if (t1)
15065 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15066 }
15067 }
15068 }
15069
15070 struct tracepoint *
15071 get_tracepoint (int num)
15072 {
15073 struct breakpoint *t;
15074
15075 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15076 if (t->number == num)
15077 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15078
15079 return NULL;
15080 }
15081
15082 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
15083 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
15084 reconnecting). */
15085
15086 struct tracepoint *
15087 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
15088 {
15089 struct breakpoint *b;
15090
15091 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15092 {
15093 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15094
15095 if (t->number_on_target == num)
15096 return t;
15097 }
15098
15099 return NULL;
15100 }
15101
15102 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
15103 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
15104 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
15105 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
15106
15107 struct tracepoint *
15108 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg,
15109 number_or_range_parser *parser)
15110 {
15111 struct breakpoint *t;
15112 int tpnum;
15113 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
15114
15115 if (parser != NULL)
15116 {
15117 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
15118 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
15119 }
15120 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
15121 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
15122 else
15123 tpnum = get_number (arg);
15124
15125 if (tpnum <= 0)
15126 {
15127 if (instring && *instring)
15128 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
15129 instring);
15130 else
15131 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
15132 return NULL;
15133 }
15134
15135 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15136 if (t->number == tpnum)
15137 {
15138 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15139 }
15140
15141 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
15142 return NULL;
15143 }
15144
15145 void
15146 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15147 {
15148 if (b->thread != -1)
15149 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15150
15151 if (b->task != 0)
15152 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15153
15154 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15155 }
15156
15157 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15158 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15159 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15160 non-zero. */
15161
15162 static void
15163 save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
15164 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15165 {
15166 struct breakpoint *tp;
15167 int any = 0;
15168 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15169
15170 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15171 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15172
15173 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15174 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15175 {
15176 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15177 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15178 continue;
15179
15180 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15181 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15182 continue;
15183
15184 any = 1;
15185
15186 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15187 {
15188 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15189
15190 /* We can stop searching. */
15191 break;
15192 }
15193 }
15194
15195 if (!any)
15196 {
15197 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15198 return;
15199 }
15200
15201 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
15202
15203 stdio_file fp;
15204
15205 if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
15206 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15207 expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
15208
15209 if (extra_trace_bits)
15210 save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
15211
15212 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15213 {
15214 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15215 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15216 continue;
15217
15218 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15219 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15220 continue;
15221
15222 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
15223
15224 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15225 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15226 instead. */
15227
15228 if (tp->cond_string)
15229 fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15230
15231 if (tp->ignore_count)
15232 fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15233
15234 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15235 {
15236 fp.puts (" commands\n");
15237
15238 current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
15239 TRY
15240 {
15241 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
15242 }
15243 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15244 {
15245 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15246 throw_exception (ex);
15247 }
15248 END_CATCH
15249
15250 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15251 fp.puts (" end\n");
15252 }
15253
15254 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15255 fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
15256
15257 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15258 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15259 special, and not user visible. */
15260 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15261 {
15262 struct bp_location *loc;
15263 int n = 1;
15264
15265 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15266 if (!loc->enabled)
15267 fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15268 }
15269 }
15270
15271 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15272 fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15273
15274 if (from_tty)
15275 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
15276 }
15277
15278 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15279
15280 static void
15281 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15282 {
15283 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15284 }
15285
15286 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15287
15288 static void
15289 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15290 {
15291 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15292 }
15293
15294 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15295
15296 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
15297 all_tracepoints (void)
15298 {
15299 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
15300 struct breakpoint *tp;
15301
15302 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15303 {
15304 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
15305 }
15306
15307 return tp_vec;
15308 }
15309
15310 \f
15311 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15312 locations used by several commands. */
15313
15314 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15315 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15316 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15317 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15318 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15319 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15320 \n\
15321 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15322 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15323 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15324 \n\
15325 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15326 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15327 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15328 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15329 -function fact -label the_top\".\n"
15330
15331 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15332 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15333 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15334 command. */
15335
15336 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15337 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15338 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15339 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15340 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15341 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15342 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15343 below.\n\
15344 \n\
15345 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15346 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15347 \n\
15348 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15349 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15350 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15351 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15352 conditions are different.\n\
15353 \n\
15354 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15355
15356 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15357 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15358
15359 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15360 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15361
15362 void
15363 add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
15364 cmd_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15365 completer_ftype *completer,
15366 void *user_data_catch,
15367 void *user_data_tcatch)
15368 {
15369 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15370
15371 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15372 &catch_cmdlist);
15373 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15374 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15375 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15376
15377 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15378 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15379 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15380 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15381 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15382 }
15383
15384 static void
15385 save_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
15386 {
15387 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15388 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15389 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15390 }
15391
15392 struct breakpoint *
15393 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15394 void *data)
15395 {
15396 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15397
15398 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15399 {
15400 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15401 return b;
15402 }
15403
15404 return NULL;
15405 }
15406
15407 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15408 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15409
15410 static int
15411 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15412 {
15413 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15414 non-inline function. */
15415 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15416 return 1;
15417
15418 return 0;
15419 }
15420
15421 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15422 have been inlined. */
15423
15424 int
15425 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15426 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15427 {
15428 struct breakpoint *b;
15429 struct bp_location *bl;
15430
15431 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15432 {
15433 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15434 continue;
15435
15436 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15437 {
15438 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15439 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15440 return 1;
15441 }
15442 }
15443
15444 return 0;
15445 }
15446
15447 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15448
15449 void
15450 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15451 {
15452 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15453
15454 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15455 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15456 loc->symtab = NULL;
15457 }
15458
15459 void
15460 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15461 {
15462 static int initialized = 0;
15463
15464 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15465
15466 if (initialized)
15467 return;
15468 initialized = 1;
15469
15470 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15471 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15472 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15473 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15474 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15475 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15476 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15477 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15478 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15479 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15480 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15481 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15482
15483 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15484 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15485 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15486 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15487 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15488 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15489 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15490 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15491
15492 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15493 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15494 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15495 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15496 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15497 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15498 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15499 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15500 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15501 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15502
15503 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15504 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15505 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15506 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15507 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15508 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15509 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15510
15511 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15512 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15513 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15514 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15515 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15516 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15517 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15518
15519 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15520 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15521 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15522 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15523 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15524 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15525 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15526
15527 /* Watchpoints. */
15528 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15529 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15530 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15531 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15532 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15533 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15534 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15535 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15536 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15537 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15538 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15539 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15540 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15541
15542 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15543 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15544 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15545 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15546 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15547 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15548 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15549 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15550 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15551 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15552 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15553
15554 /* Tracepoints. */
15555 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15556 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15557 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15558 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15559 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15560 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15561 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15562 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15563 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15564 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15565
15566 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15567 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15568 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15569 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15570 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15571
15572 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15573 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15574 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15575 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15576 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15577 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15578
15579 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15580 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15581 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15582 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15583 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15584 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15585 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15586 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15587 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15588 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15589
15590 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15591 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15592 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15593 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15594 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15595 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15596 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15597 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15598 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15599 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15600
15601 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15602 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15603 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15604 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15605 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15606 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15607 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15608 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15609 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15610 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15611
15612 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15613 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15614 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15615 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15616 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15617 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15618 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15619 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15620 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15621 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15622 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15623
15624 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15625 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15626 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15627 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15628 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15629 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15630 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15631 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15632 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15633 }
15634
15635 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15636
15637 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15638
15639 void
15640 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
15641 {
15642 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15643
15644 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15645
15646 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
15647 observer_attach_free_objfile (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
15648 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
15649
15650 breakpoint_objfile_key
15651 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_objfile_data);
15652
15653 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15654 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15655 before a breakpoint is set. */
15656 breakpoint_count = 0;
15657
15658 tracepoint_count = 0;
15659
15660 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15661 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15662 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15663
15664 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
15665 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
15666 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15667 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
15668 (e.g. `5-7').\n\
15669 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15670 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15671 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15672 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15673 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15674
15675 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
15676 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15677 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
15678 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
15679 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
15680
15681 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15682 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15683 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15684 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15685 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15686 \n"
15687 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15688 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15689
15690 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15691 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15692 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15693 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15694 \n"
15695 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15696 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15697
15698 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15699 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15700 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15701 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15702 \n"
15703 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15704 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15705
15706 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15707 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15708 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15709 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15710 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15711 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15712 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15713
15714 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15715
15716 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15717 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15718 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15719 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15720 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
15721 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
15722
15723 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15724 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15725 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15726 &enablebreaklist);
15727
15728 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15729 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15730 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15731 &enablebreaklist);
15732
15733 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15734 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15735 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15736 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15737 &enablebreaklist);
15738
15739 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15740 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15741 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15742 &enablelist);
15743
15744 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15745 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15746 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15747 &enablelist);
15748
15749 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15750 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15751 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15752 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15753 &enablelist);
15754
15755 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15756 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15757 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15758 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15759 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15760 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15761 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15762 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15763
15764 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
15765 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15766 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15767 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15768 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15769 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15770 &disablelist);
15771
15772 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15773 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15774 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15775 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15776 \n\
15777 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
15778 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
15779 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
15780 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15781 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15782
15783 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
15784 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15785 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15786 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15787 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15788 &deletelist);
15789
15790 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15791 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15792 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15793 \n\
15794 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15795 is executing in.\n"
15796 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15797 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15798 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
15799
15800 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15801 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15802 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15803 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15804
15805 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
15806 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
15807 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
15808 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
15809
15810 if (dbx_commands)
15811 {
15812 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
15813 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15814 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
15815 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
15816 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
15817 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
15818 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
15819 add_com ("status", class_info, info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15820 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15821 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15822 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15823 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15824 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15825 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15826 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15827 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15828 \n\
15829 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15830 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15831 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15832 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15833 breakpoint set."));
15834 }
15835
15836 add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15837 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15838 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15839 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15840 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15841 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15842 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15843 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15844 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15845 \n\
15846 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15847 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15848 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15849 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15850 breakpoint set."));
15851
15852 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
15853
15854 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15855 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15856 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15857 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15858 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15859 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15860 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15861 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15862 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15863 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15864 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15865 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15866 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15867 \n\
15868 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15869 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15870 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15871 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15872 breakpoint set."),
15873 &maintenanceinfolist);
15874
15875 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
15876 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15877 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
15878 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15879
15880 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
15881 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15882 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
15883 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15884
15885 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15886 catch_fork_command_1,
15887 NULL,
15888 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
15889 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
15890 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15891 catch_fork_command_1,
15892 NULL,
15893 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
15894 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
15895 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15896 catch_exec_command_1,
15897 NULL,
15898 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15899 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15900 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15901 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15902 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15903 catch_load_command_1,
15904 NULL,
15905 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15906 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15907 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15908 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15909 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15910 catch_unload_command_1,
15911 NULL,
15912 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15913 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15914
15915 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
15916 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15917 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15918 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15919 an expression changes.\n\
15920 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15921 the memory to which it refers."));
15922 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15923
15924 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
15925 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15926 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15927 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15928 an expression is read.\n\
15929 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15930 the memory to which it refers."));
15931 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15932
15933 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
15934 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15935 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15936 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15937 an expression is either read or written.\n\
15938 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15939 the memory to which it refers."));
15940 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15941
15942 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
15943 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15944
15945 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15946 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15947 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
15948 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
15949 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15950 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15951 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15952 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15953 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15954 hardware.)"),
15955 NULL,
15956 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
15957 &setlist, &showlist);
15958
15959 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
15960
15961 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15962
15963 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
15964 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15965 \n"
15966 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15967 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15968 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15969
15970 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
15971 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15972 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15973 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15974
15975 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
15976 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15977 \n"
15978 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15979 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15980 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15981
15982 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
15983 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15984 \n\
15985 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15986 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15987 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15988 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15989 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15990 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15991 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15992 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15993 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15994 \n\
15995 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15996 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15997 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15998 conditions are different.\n\
15999 \n\
16000 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
16001 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16002 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16003
16004 add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
16005 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
16006 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
16007 last tracepoint set."));
16008
16009 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
16010
16011 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
16012 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
16013 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16014 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
16015 &deletelist);
16016 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
16017
16018 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
16019 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
16020 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16021 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
16022 &disablelist);
16023 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
16024
16025 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
16026 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
16027 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16028 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
16029 &enablelist);
16030 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
16031
16032 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
16033 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
16034 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
16035 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
16036 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
16037
16038 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
16039 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
16040 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
16041 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16042
16043 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
16044 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
16045 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
16046 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
16047 session to restore them."),
16048 &save_cmdlist);
16049 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16050
16051 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
16052 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
16053 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
16054 &save_cmdlist);
16055 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16056
16057 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
16058 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
16059
16060 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16061 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16062 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16063 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16064 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
16065 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
16066 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16067 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16068 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16069 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16070 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
16071 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
16072
16073 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
16074 &pending_break_support, _("\
16075 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16076 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16077 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
16078 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
16079 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
16080 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
16081 NULL,
16082 show_pending_break_support,
16083 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16084 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16085
16086 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
16087
16088 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
16089 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
16090 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16091 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16092 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
16093 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
16094 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
16095 NULL,
16096 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
16097 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16098 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16099
16100 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
16101 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
16102 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16103 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16104 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
16105 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
16106 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
16107 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
16108 when execution stops."),
16109 NULL,
16110 &show_always_inserted_mode,
16111 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16112 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16113
16114 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
16115 condition_evaluation_enums,
16116 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
16117 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16118 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16119 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
16120 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
16121 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
16122 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
16123 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
16124 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
16125 be set to \"gdb\""),
16126 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
16127 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
16128 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16129 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16130
16131 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16132 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16133 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16134 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16135 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16136 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16137 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16138 or the start of the range\n\
16139 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16140 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16141 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16142 \n\
16143 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16144 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16145 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16146
16147 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16148 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
16149 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16150 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
16151 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
16152 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16153
16154 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16155 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16156 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16157 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16158 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16159 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16160 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16161 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16162 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16163 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16164 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16165 &setlist, &showlist);
16166
16167 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16168 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16169 &dprintf_function, _("\
16170 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16171 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16172 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16173 &setlist, &showlist);
16174
16175 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16176 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16177 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16178 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16179 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16180 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16181 &setlist, &showlist);
16182
16183 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16184 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16185 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16186 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16187 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16188 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16189 NULL,
16190 NULL,
16191 &setlist, &showlist);
16192
16193 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16194 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16195 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16196
16197 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16198
16199 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16200 observer_attach_thread_exit (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
16201 }
This page took 0.543873 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.